WO2022218305A1 - 信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备 - Google Patents

信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备 Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2022218305A1
WO2022218305A1 PCT/CN2022/086364 CN2022086364W WO2022218305A1 WO 2022218305 A1 WO2022218305 A1 WO 2022218305A1 CN 2022086364 W CN2022086364 W CN 2022086364W WO 2022218305 A1 WO2022218305 A1 WO 2022218305A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
antenna panel
information
preset
target antenna
side device
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/CN2022/086364
Other languages
English (en)
French (fr)
Inventor
杨宇
Original Assignee
维沃移动通信有限公司
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by 维沃移动通信有限公司 filed Critical 维沃移动通信有限公司
Publication of WO2022218305A1 publication Critical patent/WO2022218305A1/zh

Links

Images

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W36/00Hand-off or reselection arrangements
    • H04W36/06Reselecting a communication resource in the serving access point
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W72/00Local resource management
    • H04W72/04Wireless resource allocation
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W72/00Local resource management
    • H04W72/04Wireless resource allocation
    • H04W72/044Wireless resource allocation based on the type of the allocated resource
    • H04W72/046Wireless resource allocation based on the type of the allocated resource the resource being in the space domain, e.g. beams
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04WWIRELESS COMMUNICATION NETWORKS
    • H04W72/00Local resource management
    • H04W72/50Allocation or scheduling criteria for wireless resources
    • H04W72/54Allocation or scheduling criteria for wireless resources based on quality criteria

Definitions

  • the present application belongs to the field of communication technologies, and in particular relates to an information signal updating method, a terminal and a network side device.
  • MPUE Multi-panel User Equipment
  • the embodiments of the present application provide an information signal update method, terminal, and network side device, which can solve the problem of data transmission failure or performance loss caused by the inability of UE and network side handover time to align.
  • a method for updating an information signal comprising:
  • the terminal sets the application time after the network side device issues the first instruction command, and completes the update of the information signal
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or, Determined by the agreement according to at least one of the following:
  • an apparatus for updating an information signal comprising:
  • a first processing module configured to set the application time after the network-side device issues the first instruction command, and complete the update of the information signal
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or is determined by the protocol
  • the agreement is determined according to at least one of the following:
  • a method for updating an information signal which is applied to a network side device, and the method includes:
  • the network side device issues a first instruction command, and completes the update of the information signal at a set application time after the first instruction command is issued;
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or is determined by the protocol
  • the agreement is determined according to at least one of the following:
  • an apparatus for updating an information signal including:
  • a second processing module configured to issue a first instruction command, and complete the update of the information signal at the set application time after the first instruction command is issued;
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command
  • the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or is determined by the agreement according to the Determine at least one of the following:
  • a terminal in a fifth aspect, includes a processor, a memory, and a program or instruction stored on the memory and executable on the processor, when the program or instruction is executed by the processor.
  • a terminal including a processor and a communication interface, wherein the processor is configured to complete the update of the information signal by setting the application time after the network side device issues the first instruction command; wherein , the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or, by The agreement is determined according to at least one of the following:
  • a network side device in a seventh aspect, includes a processor, a memory, and a program or instruction stored on the memory and executable on the processor, the program or instruction being executed by the The processor implements the steps of the method as described in the third aspect when executed.
  • a network-side device including a processor and a communication interface, wherein the processor is configured to issue a first instruction command, and set an application time after the first instruction command is issued, and complete the The update of the information signal; wherein, the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is set by the network side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the terminal determined by the capability information, or determined by the agreement according to at least one of the following:
  • a readable storage medium is provided, and a program or an instruction is stored on the readable storage medium, and when the program or instruction is executed by a processor, the steps of the method described in the first aspect are implemented, or the steps as described in the first aspect are implemented. The steps of the method described in the third aspect.
  • a tenth aspect provides a chip, the chip includes a processor and a communication interface, the communication interface is coupled to the processor, and the processor is configured to run a program or an instruction to implement the method according to the first aspect , or implement the method described in the third aspect.
  • a computer program/program product is provided, the computer program/program product is stored in a non-transitory storage medium, the program/program product is executed by at least one processor to implement the first The steps of the method of the aspect, or the steps of implementing the method of the third aspect.
  • the network-side device instructs the update of the information signal through the instruction command, according to the determined activation state of the target antenna panel, the application time for realizing the update is set, and at the application time, the network is completed.
  • the update of the information signal indicated by the side can align the update time of the network side and the UE, so that the correct beam link can be maintained and the data transmission performance can be guaranteed.
  • FIG. 1 is a structural diagram of a wireless communication system to which an embodiment of the application can be applied;
  • FIG. 2 is one of the schematic flowcharts of a method for updating an information signal provided by an embodiment of the present application
  • FIG. 3 is one of the schematic structural diagrams of an apparatus for updating an information signal provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 4 is a second schematic flowchart of a method for updating an information signal provided by an embodiment of the present application
  • FIG. 5 is a second schematic structural diagram of an apparatus for updating an information signal provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 6 is a schematic structural diagram of a communication device provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 7 is a schematic diagram of a hardware structure of a terminal implementing an embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 8 is a schematic diagram of a hardware structure of a network side device implementing an embodiment of the present application.
  • first, second and the like in the description and claims of the present application are used to distinguish similar objects, and are not used to describe a specific order or sequence. It is to be understood that the terms so used are interchangeable under appropriate circumstances so that the embodiments of the present application can be practiced in sequences other than those illustrated or described herein, and that "first”, “second” distinguishes Usually it is a class, and the number of objects is not limited.
  • the first object may be one or more than one.
  • “and/or” in the description and claims indicates at least one of the connected objects, and the character “/" generally indicates that the associated objects are in an "or” relationship.
  • LTE Long Term Evolution
  • LTE-Advanced LTE-Advanced
  • LTE-A Long Term Evolution-Advanced
  • CDMA Code Division Multiple Access
  • TDMA Time Division Multiple Access
  • FDMA Frequency Division Multiple Access
  • OFDMA Orthogonal Frequency Division Multiple Access
  • SC-FDMA Single-carrier Frequency-Division Multiple Access
  • system and “network” in the embodiments of the present application are often used interchangeably, and the described technology can be used not only for the above-mentioned systems and radio technologies, but also for other systems and radio technologies.
  • NR New Radio
  • the following description describes a New Radio (NR) system for example purposes, and uses NR terminology in most of the description below, but the techniques can also be applied to applications other than NR system applications, such as 6th generation (6th generation ) Generation, 6G) communication system.
  • 6th generation 6th generation
  • 6G 6th generation
  • FIG. 1 shows a structural diagram of a wireless communication system to which an embodiment of the present application can be applied.
  • the wireless communication system includes a terminal 101 and a network-side device 102.
  • the terminal 101 may also be called a terminal device or a user terminal (User Equipment, UE), and the terminal 101 may be a mobile phone, a tablet computer (Tablet Personal Computer), a laptop computer (Laptop Computer) or a notebook computer, a personal digital computer Assistant (Personal Digital Assistant, PDA), handheld computer, netbook, ultra-mobile personal computer (ultra-mobile personal computer, UMPC), mobile Internet device (Mobile Internet Device, MID), wearable device (Wearable Device) or vehicle-mounted device (VUE), pedestrian terminal (PUE) and other terminal-side devices, wearable devices include: smart watches, bracelets, headphones, glasses, etc.
  • the network-side device 102 may be a base station or a core network, where the base station may be referred to as a Node B, an evolved Node B, an access point, a Base Transceiver Station (BTS), a radio base station, a radio transceiver, a basic service Set (Basic Service Set, BSS), Extended Service Set (Extended Service Set, ESS), Node B, Evolved Node B (eNB), Home Node B, Home Evolved Node B, WLAN Access Point, WiFi Node, Send Transmitting Receiving Point (TRP) or some other suitable term in the field, as long as the same technical effect is achieved, the base station is not limited to specific technical terms.
  • the base station in the NR system is taken as an example, but the specific type of the base station is not limited.
  • the core network equipment may include, but is not limited to, at least one of the following: core network node, core network function, mobility management entity (Mobility Management Entity, MME), access mobility management function (Access and Mobility Management Function, AMF), session management function (Session Management Function, SMF), User Plane Function (UPF), Policy Control Function (Policy Control Function, PCF), Policy and Charging Rules Function (Policy and Charging Rules Function, PCRF), edge application services Discovery function (Edge Application Server Discovery Function, EASDF), Unified Data Management (Unified Data Management, UDM), Unified Data Repository (Unified Data Repository, UDR), Home Subscriber Server (Home Subscriber Server, HSS), centralized network configuration ( Centralized network configuration, CNC), Network Repository Function (NRF), Network Exposure Function (NEF), Local NEF (Local NEF, or L-NEF), Binding Support Function (Binding Support Function,
  • FIG. 2 is one of the schematic flowcharts of a method for updating an information signal provided by an embodiment of the present application.
  • the method may be executed by a terminal, and the terminal may specifically be the terminal 101 shown in FIG. 1 .
  • the method includes:
  • Step 201 the terminal sets the application time after the network side device sends the first instruction command, and completes the update of the information signal.
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or, Determined by the agreement according to at least one of the following:
  • the network side device may issue an instruction command to the terminal to indicate that the update needs to be performed and the specific information signal involved in the update.
  • the indication command may be referred to as a first indication command, and a specific information signal to be updated may be indicated by the first indication command.
  • the network-side device can make beam indications for the downlink and uplink channels or reference signals, that is, issue a first indication command for A beam link is established or updated or switched between the network side equipment and the terminal UE to realize the transmission of channels or reference signals.
  • the terminal can determine whether the set application time has arrived, and when the set application time has arrived, complete or implement the update of the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, that is, The update to the indicated information signal takes effect.
  • the information signal may be beam information in the beam switching process, may also be the path loss reference signal (Pathloss Reference Signal, PLRS) in the path loss reference signal update process, or may also be the tracking reference signal triggering or configuration or activation process
  • the tracking reference signal (Tracking Reference Signal, TRS) in or may also be other types of reference signals or information, which are not limited in this embodiment of the present application.
  • the following may take the beam switching process as an example to describe the technical solutions of the embodiments of the present application.
  • the above beam information may also be referred to as: spatial relation information, spatial domain transmission filter information, spatial domain reception filter information, and spatial domain filter (spatial domain reception filter) information.
  • spatial filter information, Transceiver Configuration Indicator state (TCI state) information, Quasi Co-Location (QCL) information or QCL parameters, etc.
  • TCI state Transceiver Configuration Indicator state
  • QCL Quasi Co-Location
  • the downlink beam information can usually be represented by TCI state information or QCL information
  • the uplink beam information can usually be represented by TCI state information or spatial relationship information.
  • the set application time is a specific time point after the first instruction command, and the specific time point may be agreed in advance by a protocol or configured by a network side device. Specifically, it can be determined by the network-side device according to at least one of the activation state of the target antenna panel and the capability information of the terminal, for example, only determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel, or only determined according to the capability information of the terminal, or combined with the target antenna
  • the activation state of the panel and the capability information of the terminal are determined; it can also be determined by the protocol as a fixed time point, that is, a preset fixed constant, or a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel, or a combination of the two.
  • the larger of the preset fixed constant and the value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel may be determined as the set application time.
  • the target antenna panel is one or more antenna panels in the multi-panel terminal, which is the target information signal indicated by the first instruction command or the antenna panel associated with or corresponding to the reference signal in the target information signal.
  • the target antenna panel is the antenna panel to which the network-side device indicates that the beam to be switched to belongs.
  • the antenna panel may also be referred to as: antenna group, antenna port group, antenna set, antenna port set, beam set, beam sub-set, antenna array, antenna port array, antenna sub-array, antenna port sub-array, logical entity, entity or antenna entity, etc.
  • the application time for realizing the update is set, and at the application time , to complete the update of the information signal indicated by the network side, so that the update time of the network side and the UE can be aligned, so that the correct beam link can be maintained and the data transmission performance can be guaranteed.
  • the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first indication command indicates a group of information signals
  • there is at least one information signal in the group of information signals or at least one reference signal in the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel, by The identification information determines the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal
  • the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal is determined according to the identification information of the antenna panel corresponding to at least one information signal included in the first instruction command .
  • the embodiment of the present application determines the need to set the application time according to the activation state information of the target antenna panel as a premise, that is, it is necessary to determine one or more applications that need to be applied from multiple antenna panels of the terminal. one antenna panel as the target antenna panel.
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the antenna panel associated with the at least one information signal or the reference signal in the at least one information signal is used as the target antenna panel.
  • the first indication command indicates a group of information signals
  • there is at least one information signal in the group of information signals (or in the first indication command) that corresponds to the identification information of the antenna panel then the at least one information signal is used as the information signal.
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the corresponding antenna panel is used as the target antenna panel.
  • two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined according to the above two methods respectively, and then the final target antenna panel may be determined according to the two groups of candidate target antenna panels.
  • the antenna panels included in the two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined as the final target antenna panels.
  • the identification information of the antenna panel may be: an identification of the antenna panel, a reference signal resource identification, a reference signal resource set identification, a TCI state identification, a QCL information identification or a spatial relationship identification, etc., which are not limited in the embodiments of the present application.
  • the target panel can be determined according to the target panel identification information associated with the TCI status information; or, according to the target panel identification information associated with the reference signal in the TCI status information Determine the target panel; or, the first indication command includes the identification information of the target panel corresponding to the TCI status information, according to which the target panel can be determined.
  • the final target antenna is determined by determining the information signal indicated by the first instruction command or the identification information of the antenna panel associated with the reference signal in the information signal, or the identification information of the antenna panel included in the first instruction command. panel, which can update the target information signal more accurately.
  • the target antenna panel is determined as follows: there is at least one information signal or at least one information signal in the group of information signals.
  • the reference signal is associated with multiple antenna panel identification information
  • the information signal indicated by the first instruction command or the reference signal in the information signal is associated with multiple antenna panel identification information, and it is necessary to select the corresponding multiple antenna panel identification information according to the situation.
  • the final target antenna panel is determined from the antenna panels.
  • the corresponding antenna panels may be determined directly according to the multiple antenna panel identification information associated with the information signals associated with the multiple antenna panel identification information. Then, multiple antenna panels can be obtained according to the identification information of the multiple antenna panels, so the multiple antenna panels can be determined as the target antenna panels corresponding to the information signal, and there are multiple corresponding target antenna panels.
  • one (or multiple) target antenna panel identification information may also be determined from the plurality of antenna panel identification information according to a preset rule, and the corresponding antenna panel may be used as the target antenna panel. Since there is a correspondence between the identification information of the antenna panel and the antenna panel, this solution can also be understood as determining one (or multiple) as the target antenna panel from the multiple antenna panels corresponding to the multiple antenna panel representation information .
  • the preset rule may be referred to as the first preset rule.
  • the first preset rule includes at least one of the following:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the multiple antenna panel identification information, compare the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values corresponding to the multiple antenna panel identification information respectively, and determining the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information corresponding to the largest one of the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values as the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal;
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the plurality of antenna panel identification information
  • the target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal In the case that the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the plurality of antenna panel identification information, determine the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information arranged in the preset position as the at least one antenna panel The target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal.
  • the L1-RSRP/L1- The SINR value dimension and/or the arrangement position dimension of the antenna panel identification information evaluate the identification information of each antenna panel, determine one (or multiple) antenna panel identification information, and determine its corresponding antenna panel as The target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal associated with the above-mentioned plurality of antenna panel identification information.
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information and the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value corresponding to each antenna panel identification information, then by comparing these L1-RSRP/L1 -SINR value, determine the largest among them, that is, the largest L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value, and determine the antenna panel corresponding to the corresponding antenna panel identification information as the one associated with the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information The target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal.
  • the positions where the identification information of these antenna panels are arranged respectively can be determined, and based on this, the antennas arranged at the preset positions can be determined.
  • Panel identification information so that the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information can be further determined, and determined as the target antenna panel corresponding to the information signals associated with the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information.
  • two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined according to the above two methods respectively, and then the final target antenna panel may be determined according to the two groups of candidate target antenna panels.
  • the antenna panels included in the two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined as the final target antenna panels.
  • the CRI corresponds to multiple panel identification information and multiple L1-RSRP values, wherein the panel identification and L1-RSRP values are in one-to-one correspondence. If the TCI state information indicated by the first indication command is determined according to the CRI, the multiple panel identification information corresponding to the CRI may be used as target panel identification information.
  • one (or more) of the multiple panel identification information corresponding to the CRI is used as the target panel identification information, for example, the maximum value of the L1-RSRP values corresponding to the multiple panel identification information is The panel identification information corresponding to the L1-RSRP value is determined as the target panel identification information; or, the panel identification information of the plurality of panel identification information arranged at the foremost position in the beam report is used as the target panel identification information.
  • association described in the above embodiment includes at least one of the following:
  • the information signal includes identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the configuration information of the reference signal in the information signal includes the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel or the number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel is included;
  • the network side device indicates that the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the network side device indicates that the reference signal in the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the reference signal in the information signal is determined based on the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device, and the beam report includes SSBRI/CRI and the target antenna panel corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI identification information.
  • the association relationship between the information signal or the reference information in the information signal and the identification information of the target antenna panel in the embodiment of the present application mainly includes the following forms: directly contained (for example, contained in the TCI status information),
  • the configuration/resource set/group/subset/resource to which it belongs includes (for example, in the configuration information resource setting or resource config of the reference signal of the information signal, in the resource set information of the reference signal resource set, the reference signal resource subset resource subset information, in the reference signal group resource group information, in the reference signal resource resource information), the network side device indicates the association and the association through the beam report, etc., which can be specifically represented as at least one of the association relationships listed above.
  • the terminal first reports a beam report to the network side device, and the beam report will include SSBRI/CRI, as well as the identification information of the antenna panel corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI and The L1-RSRP/L1-SINR corresponding to these identification information.
  • the network side device can select the reference signal information corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI according to the antenna panel and its corresponding L1-RSRP/L1-SINR in the beam report, and indicate a group of information signals accordingly.
  • the indicated information signal or the reference signal in the information signal is associated with the based SSBRI/CRI, and further due to the correspondence between the SSBRI/CRI and the identification information of the antenna panel, the indicated information signal or the reference signal in the information signal is generated The relationship between the signal and the identification information of the antenna panel.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first report sent by the terminal to the network-side device includes the activation state information of the target antenna panel, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel according to the first report;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel is included in the beam report sent by the terminal to the network-side device, determine that the activation state of the target antenna panel is the activated state, otherwise, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the activated state is the deactivated state
  • the target antenna panels are multiple target antenna panels, determining the activation states of the multiple target antenna panels according to a second preset rule;
  • the target antenna panel is a plurality of target antenna panels
  • the activation state of the plurality of target antenna panels is self-determined by the terminal.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel can be finally determined according to any one or a combination of any of the above-listed methods for determining the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the UE may send the first report to the network side device to report the activation state of the target antenna panel. That is, the UE may report the first report, and the characteristics of the first report include: the activation state information of the panel, for example, at least one of the activated state, the deactivated state, the downlink-only active state, the uplink-only active state, etc. one.
  • the first report may be different from the beam report, or the same report as the beam report.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel is determined according to whether the identification information of the target antenna panel is included in the beam report. That is, it is determined that the panel corresponding to the panel identification information not included in the beam report is in the deactivated state, and the panel corresponding to the panel identification information included in the beam report is regarded as the active state.
  • the activation state of each target antenna panel is determined by the terminal according to a preset rule or by itself.
  • the terminal can determine the state of the panels corresponding to the multiple panel identification information by itself. Each panel corresponding to the panel identification information is in the active state.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel may be finally determined by combining any of the above determination methods.
  • the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be the active state in various ways is confirmed to be the active state, or the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be in the active state according to various methods is that the number of active states exceeds the set threshold
  • the state is confirmed to be active state, the embodiments of the present application are not limited.
  • the second preset rule includes:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the identification information of the multiple target antenna panels, compare the L1-RSRP/L1- SINR value, and determine the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the first M larger values in the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value as the active state, and determine the L1-RSRP/
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values other than the first M larger values in the L1-SINR value is determined to be a deactivated state, and M is a positive integer;
  • the identification information corresponding to the P target antenna panels arranged in the preset positions will be The antenna panel is determined to be in an active state, and the antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panels except the identification information of the P target antenna panels are determined to be in a deactivated state, and P is a positive integer;
  • a plurality of target antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the plurality of target antenna panels are all determined to be in an active state.
  • the dimension of the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value corresponding to the antenna panel identification information and/or the arrangement position dimension of the antenna panel identification information can be used for each Antenna panel identification information is evaluated to determine the activation status of the corresponding target antenna panel.
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information and the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value corresponding to each antenna panel identification information, then by comparing these L1-RSRP/L1 - SINR value, determine the larger M, that is, the first M larger values, and determine the antenna panels corresponding to the antenna panel identification information corresponding to the first M larger values as the active state. For other L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values except the first M larger values among these L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values, the antenna panel identification information corresponding to the other L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values respectively corresponds to The antenna panel is determined to be in the deactivated state.
  • the positions where these antenna panel identification information are arranged respectively can be determined, and based on this, the P The identification information of the P antenna panels can be further determined, and the P target antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the P antenna panels can be further determined, and the activation state of the P target antenna panels can be determined as the activated state.
  • Target antenna panels other than the P target antenna panels are determined to be in a deactivated state.
  • the target antenna panels corresponding to the above-mentioned identification information of the plurality of target antenna panels are all determined to be in the active state.
  • the CRI corresponds to multiple panel identification information and multiple L1-RSRP values, wherein the panel identification and L1-RSRP values are in one-to-one correspondence. If the TCI status information indicated by the first indication command is determined according to the CRI, then multiple L1-RSRP values corresponding to the CRI can be compared, arranged from large to small, and the panel identification information corresponding to the first M large values can be The panel is determined as the activated state, and the rest of the panels are determined as the deactivated state.
  • the panels corresponding to the P pieces of panel identification information that are arranged at the foremost positions in the beam report corresponding to the multiple panel identification information corresponding to the CRI are determined to be in an active state, and the remaining panels are determined to be in a deactivated state.
  • the panels corresponding to the plurality of panel identification information corresponding to the CRI are all determined to be in the active state.
  • the activation states of the corresponding two or three groups of target antenna panels to be confirmed according to any two or three of the above three methods, and then according to the two or three groups of target antennas to be confirmed. Panel activation state, and finally determine the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be the active state in various ways is confirmed to be the active state, or the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be in the active state according to various methods is that the number of active states exceeds the set threshold
  • the state is confirmed to be active state, the embodiments of the present application are not limited.
  • the UE may deactivate the panel considered to be in the deactivated state according to the above rules.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is:
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the first preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel The duration of the activation delay, or, a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the information signal is specifically beam information, path loss reference signal PLRS or tracking reference signal TRS
  • when there is at least one information signal in a group of information signals indicated by the first indication information When the target antenna panel corresponding to the target antenna panel identification information associated with the information signal or the reference signal of the at least one information signal is in the deactivated state, it is necessary to delay the first preset time period on the basis of the application time agreed in the existing protocol, Finally, the application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is obtained, that is, the application time is set.
  • the network side device may first use the first indication command to indicate a group of TCI states, wherein the first indication command indicates a group of TCI states, which may be a MAC CE command to activate a group of TCI states, or DCI to indicate a group of TCI states, And a set of TCI states includes at least one TCI state.
  • the beam application time (beam application time, BAT) is the first preset time + the first preset duration.
  • the first preset time may be the application time in the existing protocol, such as the beam application time of the existing protocol, which is usually a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the first preset duration is an additional delay related to the activation state of the target antenna panel, which may be a duration configured by the network-side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the activation delay of the antenna panel, or, based on the agreement of the protocol. The value determined by the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the application time corresponding to the at least one information signal described above, that is, the set application time may be any of the following:
  • the first preset time may be X ms, Y symbol or Z slot after the first indication command or the ACK transmission time of the first indication command, and the first preset time may be based on the UE capability reported by the UE. ) to determine that the duration satisfies the duration required for panel activation.
  • the set application time corresponding to the beam information may be the ACK time of the MAC CE+3ms+target panel activation delay.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is: a first preset time; wherein the first preset time The time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time calculated according to the above embodiment no longer includes the activation process of the target antenna panel.
  • the first preset duration That is to say, if the set of TCI states is associated with an activated panel, or the reference signals in the set of TCI states are associated with an activated panel, the set application time when the target antenna panel is in the deactivated state includes: The first preset duration of is no longer required.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time corresponding to the activated state of the target antenna panel may also be the application time in the existing protocol, such as
  • the beam application time of the existing protocol is usually a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the reference signal of the TCI state exists according to the deactivated state
  • the first preset duration in the set application time corresponding to the TCI state in the above-mentioned embodiment is required; in the group of TCI states, there is a reference signal of the TCI state
  • the first preset duration in the setting application time corresponding to the TCI state in the above-mentioned embodiment is no longer required.
  • the set application time is agreed by a protocol or fixed as a first preset by the network side device configuration. time + first preset duration, or, first preset duration; wherein, the first preset duration is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network-side device, and the first preset duration is
  • the network-side device is configured according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel activation time delay, or is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the UE may determine the activation state of the panel corresponding to the multiple panel identification information by itself.
  • the network-side device cannot know the activation state of the panel, and can always use one of the following as the set application time:
  • the first preset time and the first preset duration may be the same as those in the above-mentioned embodiments, which will not be repeated here.
  • the set application time is fixed as the first preset time + the first preset duration, or, the first preset time;
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network-side device, and the first preset time is agreed in the protocol as a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel or a
  • the network-side device is configured according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the duration of the activation delay of the antenna panel.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel may not be considered, and the set application time is always set as a specific time. like:
  • the first preset time and the first preset duration may be the same as those in the above-mentioned embodiments, which will not be repeated here.
  • the first preset time in the application time corresponding to the PLRS may be the application time agreed in the existing protocol+N samples.
  • the UE can track/measure a set of TCI states, or track/measure the reference signal in each TCI state in a set of TCI states.
  • the set application time is the first time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • Application time, the first application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • pathloss RS pathloss RS
  • PLRS path loss reference signal
  • its application time can be determined according to the state of the panel associated with the PLRS, which can be referred to as the first application time to distinguish it from the general set application time in the above embodiment.
  • the first application time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated can use the application time in the existing protocol + the third preset time length, such as the ACK time of the MAC CE command + 3ms (+N samples)+the third preset duration.
  • the application time in the existing protocol may be used as the second preset time.
  • the second preset time may be the same as the first preset time in the above embodiments, or may also be the first preset time+N samples.
  • the third preset duration may be the same as the first preset duration in the foregoing embodiments.
  • the second preset time may be a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is the time length configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the activation delay of the antenna panel, or
  • the value agreed by the protocol is determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or a value determined based on the capability information of the terminal.
  • the set application time is the second application corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • the second application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or determined based on the capability information of the terminal value.
  • the third preset duration in the above embodiment is no longer required. That is, if the panel associated with the updated PLRS is in the active state, the application time in the existing protocol is used as the first application time of the corresponding PLRS, such as the ACK time+3ms of the MAC CE command, or the ACK time+3ms+N sample.
  • the second preset time may be one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the second preset time independent of the state of the target antenna panel may be the above-mentioned embodiment. any of the listed.
  • the set application time is a third application time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated, and the third application time is fixed to one of the following: :
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the application time corresponding to the PLRS can also be directly stipulated by the protocol or configured by the network side device, without considering the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the application time of the PLRS can always be confirmed as the application time in the existing protocol + the third preset duration, such as the ACK time of the MAC CE command + 3ms (+N samples) + the third preset duration, Alternatively, always confirm the application time of the PLRS as the application time in the existing protocol, such as the ACK time of the MAC CE command + 3ms (+N samples).
  • the application time of the PLRS may always be the same as the application time BAT of the beam information, or it may always be the above-mentioned BAT+N samples.
  • N depends on UE capability, or N is a fixed value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the target antenna panel is in the active state and the embodiment in which the target antenna panel is in the deactivated state in the above-mentioned PLRS embodiment, it is possible to set the application time and the target antenna through a protocol agreement or network side device configuration.
  • the second preset time independent of the state of the panel may be any of those listed above.
  • the method for updating the information signal further includes: the terminal receives a second instruction command sent by the network side device, where the second instruction command indicates a group of path loss reference signals; then, in the In the case where at least one path loss reference signal in a set of path loss reference signals is a reference signal in any TCI state in a set of TCI states indicated by the first indication command, the at least one path loss reference signal corresponds to The application time is the set application time corresponding to any one of the TCI states, or, the set application time corresponding to the any one of the TCI states+N samples; wherein, N is a protocol agreement or the The preset constant configured by the network side device or the value determined based on the capability information of the terminal.
  • the network side equipment if the network side equipment has indicated a group of TCI states in advance, and has indicated a group of PLRS through the second instruction command, it can be judged whether the PLRS is a group of TCI indicated by the network side equipment in advance.
  • the reference signal in the state if there is at least one PLRS that is the reference signal in any TCI state in the group of TCI states, then the application time corresponding to the at least one PLRS is determined as the set application corresponding to any one TCI state time, or, for the set application time corresponding to any one of the TCI states + N samples.
  • any PLRS in a group of PLRSs is a reference signal in a TCI state in a group of TCI states
  • the application time corresponding to the PLRS is the same as the BAT in the above-mentioned embodiments or BAT+N samples.
  • any path loss reference signal in the set of path loss reference signals is not a reference signal included in any TCI state in the set of TCI states, then the application corresponding to any path loss reference signal The time is one of the following:
  • the third preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the third preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the reference signal in the state if there is any PLRS that is not the reference signal in any TCI state in the group of TCI states, then the application time corresponding to any PLRS is determined as: the application time in the existing protocol, or , the application time in the existing protocol + the third preset time length, or the BAT in the above-mentioned embodiments, or the BAT+N sample in the above-mentioned embodiments, or the BAT+N sample+ in the above-mentioned embodiments.
  • the third preset duration determines the application time according to the state of the panel associated with the PLRS, and specifically includes any one of the above listed application times.
  • the third preset time may be one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the third preset time independent of the activation state of the panel that can be agreed by the protocol or configured by the network side device is any one of the above listed application times.
  • the information signal is a tracking reference signal TRS
  • the TRS indicated by the first indication command is a periodic or semi-persistent TRS
  • the first preset corresponding to the periodic or semi-persistent TRS The time is: the transmission time of the periodic or semi-persistent TRS configured by the network side device.
  • the information signal in the above-mentioned embodiment is a tracking reference signal TRS
  • the TRS is a periodic or semi-persistent TRS
  • the first preset time in the above-mentioned embodiment is the periodic or semi-continuous TRS in the existing protocol.
  • the transmission time of the continuous TRS may specifically be the period or the transmission time of the semi-persistent TRS configured by the network side device.
  • the transmission time is determined according to the period value and offset value of the period or semi-persistent TRS transmission configured by the network side device.
  • the first preset time length needs to be added, and if the panel is activated, the first preset time length does not need to be added. Set the duration.
  • the network side device uses RRC signaling to configure the transmission time information (period value and time offset value) of the periodic TRS.
  • the time is 1ms, 6ms, 11ms... . If the corresponding target antenna panel is in the deactivated state and the activation delay of the antenna panel is 8ms, the actual transmission time of the TRS needs to delay the original transmission time by the activation delay of the antenna panel, that is, the setting application of the period TRS
  • the time is 1ms+8ms, 6ms+8ms, 11ms+8ms..., that is, 9ms, 14ms, 19ms... .
  • the first preset time is 1ms, 6ms, 11ms...
  • the first preset duration is 8ms. If the target antenna panel corresponding to the TRS is in the active state, that is, the TRS is measured by the terminal using the target antenna panel in the active state, then the first preset duration in the above set application time is no longer required, that is, the period of the TRS Set the application time to 1ms, 6ms, 11ms... .
  • the network side device uses the first indication command to trigger the aperiodic TRS, and the specific setting and application time is the same as that of beam switching and PLRS updating.
  • the network side device when the network side device triggers or configures or activates the TRS using the first instruction command, it can determine the application time of the TRS (such as the transmission time or the time when the UE measures the TRS) according to the panel state associated with the TRS as one of the following: :
  • the first preset time after the first instruction command if the target antenna panel corresponding to the TRS is an inactive panel, the first preset time length needs to be added, and if it is an activated panel, it is not necessary to add;
  • the first preset time after the ACK transmission time of the first indication command. If the target antenna panel corresponding to the TRS is an inactive panel, the first preset time length needs to be added.
  • the transmission time of the TRS, or the transmission time of the TRS + the first preset duration is always used.
  • the panel status can be determined according to the measurement results of the TRS corresponding to different panel identification information (such as the size of the measurement value, etc.), or the UE can determine the panel status by itself; and then according to the panel status , to determine the transmission time of the TRS or the time for the UE to measure the TRS.
  • the method for updating the information signal further includes: the terminal sending a beam report to the network-side device according to the measurement result.
  • the embodiment of the present application can be understood that, before the network side device issues the first instruction command to indicate the specific information signal to be updated, the terminal can first measure the beam information, and measure the beam information according to the measurement result. , generate a corresponding beam report and report it to the network side device.
  • the network-side device may issue a first instruction command according to the beam report reported by the terminal, indicating a group of beam information to be updated.
  • the network side device can configure a reference signal resource set (RS resource set) in the reference signal resource configuration (RS resource config, or RS resource setting), which includes at least one reference signal resource, such as SSB resource or CSI-RS resource.
  • the UE measures the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR of each RS resource, and reports the optimal at least one measurement result to the network.
  • the reported content may include, for example, SSBRI or CRI and its corresponding L1-RSRP/L1-SINR.
  • the panel identification information used for each L1-RSRP/L1-SINR measurement result corresponding to each SSRBI/CRI may also be reported.
  • the terminal performs information measurement after activating the antenna panel that is currently in the deactivated state, and after the information measurement is completed or after the beam report is sent, the activated antenna is The panel is then deactivated.
  • the UE when the UE performs beam measurement, it activates the antenna panel that is currently in the deactivated state to perform beam measurement, and after the beam measurement or after sending the beam report, it will be in the deactivated state.
  • the antenna panel is deactivated again, which can effectively save energy and improve the overall efficiency.
  • the terminal feeds back the beam report for the network side device to determine the reference signal in the beam indication information according to the corresponding signal in the beam report when transmitting the service next time, so as to realize the analog beam transmission.
  • the content of the beam report usually includes the identification of several optimal transmit beams and the measured received power of each transmit beam. That is, the content of the report reflects at least one optimal beam and its quality, which is used by the network to determine beam information for transmitting channels or signals with the UE.
  • the beam report includes at least one of the following information:
  • Antenna panel identification information where the antenna panel identification information corresponds to SSBRI/CRI.
  • the above-mentioned beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device may selectively include any one or a combination of any of the above-mentioned contents. For example, only include SSBRI/CRI and L1-RSRP/L1-SINR corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI, or only include the antenna panel identification information, or include both SSBRI/CRI and the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI SINR, and antenna panel identification information.
  • the antenna panel identification information may correspond to the SSBRI/CRI, that is, each SSBRI/CRI in the beam report has one or more corresponding antenna panel identification information, and the antenna panel identification information corresponding to different SSBRIs/CRIs may be the same or different.
  • the execution subject may be an information signal updating apparatus, or, in the information signal updating apparatus, the updating method for loading terminal side information signals may be executed.
  • the method's control module In the embodiments of the present application, the method for updating information signals on the terminal side performed by an information signal updating device is taken as an example to describe the updating devices for information signals provided in the embodiments of the present application.
  • FIG. 3 is one of the schematic structural diagrams of the information signal updating apparatus provided in the embodiment of the present application.
  • the updating of the information signal in the method embodiment, the device includes:
  • the first processing module 301 is configured to set the application time after the network side device sends the first instruction command, and complete the update of the information signal.
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or is determined by the protocol
  • the agreement is determined according to at least one of the following:
  • the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first indication command indicates a group of information signals
  • there is at least one information signal in the group of information signals or at least one reference signal in the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel, by The identification information determines the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal
  • the target antenna corresponding to the at least one information signal is determined according to the identification information of the antenna panel corresponding to at least one information signal included in the first instruction command panel.
  • the target antenna panel is determined as follows:
  • At least one information signal in the group of information signals or a reference signal in at least one information signal is associated with multiple antenna panel identification information
  • the first preset rule includes at least one of the following:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the multiple antenna panel identification information
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the plurality of antenna panel identification information, determine the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information arranged in the preset position as the at least one information signal Corresponding target antenna panel.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first report sent by the terminal to the network-side device includes the activation state information of the target antenna panel, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel according to the first report;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel is included in the beam report sent by the terminal to the network-side device, determine that the activation state of the target antenna panel is the active state; otherwise, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel for the deactivated state;
  • the target antenna panels are multiple target antenna panels, determining the activation states of the multiple target antenna panels according to a second preset rule;
  • the target antenna panel is a plurality of target antenna panels
  • the activation state of the plurality of target antenna panels is self-determined by the terminal.
  • the second preset rule includes:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the identification information of the multiple target antenna panels, compare the L1-RSRP/L1- SINR value, and determine the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the first M larger values in the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value as the active state, and determine the L1-RSRP/
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values other than the first M larger values in the L1-SINR value is determined to be a deactivated state, and M is a positive integer;
  • the identification information corresponding to the P target antenna panels arranged in the preset positions will be The antenna panel is determined to be in an active state, and the antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panels except the identification information of the P target antenna panels are determined to be in a deactivated state, and P is a positive integer;
  • a plurality of target antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the plurality of target antenna panels are all determined to be in an active state.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is:
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the first preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel The duration of the activation delay, or, a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is:
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in a protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time is agreed by a protocol or fixed as a first preset by the network side device configuration. time + the first preset duration, or, the first preset time;
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the first preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel The duration of the activation delay, or, a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the set application time is fixed as the first preset time + the first preset duration, or, the first preset time;
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network-side device, and the first preset time is agreed in the protocol as a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel or a
  • the network-side device is configured according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the duration of the activation delay of the antenna panel.
  • the set application time is the first time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • Application time, the first application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time is the second application corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • the second application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or determined based on the capability information of the terminal value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time is a third application time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated, and the third application time is fixed to one of the following: :
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the device for updating the information signal further includes:
  • a receiving module configured to receive a second instruction command issued by the network side device, where the second instruction command indicates a group of path loss reference signals
  • the at least one path loss reference signal in the set of path loss reference signals is a reference signal in any TCI state in a set of TCI states indicated by the first indication command
  • the at least one path loss reference signal is The application time corresponding to the loss reference signal is the set application time corresponding to any one of the TCI states, or, the set application time+N samples corresponding to the any one of the TCI states;
  • N is a protocol agreement or a preset constant configured by the network side device, or a value determined based on capability information of the terminal.
  • any path loss reference signal in the set of path loss reference signals is not a reference signal included in any TCI state in the set of TCI states, then the application corresponding to any path loss reference signal The time is one of the following:
  • the third preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the third preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the third preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the information signal is a tracking reference signal TRS
  • the TRS indicated by the first indication command is a periodic or semi-persistent TRS
  • the first preset corresponding to the periodic or semi-persistent TRS The times are:
  • the transmission time of the periodic or semi-persistent TRS configured by the network side device is configured by the network side device.
  • the association includes at least one of the following:
  • the information signal includes identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the configuration information of the reference signal in the information signal includes the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel or the number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel is included;
  • the network side device indicates that the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the network side device indicates that the reference signal in the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the reference signal in the information signal is determined based on the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device, and the beam report includes SSBRI/CRI and the target antenna panel corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI identification information.
  • the apparatus for updating the information signal further includes a first sending module, configured to: before the network-side device issues the first instruction command, send a beam to the network-side device according to a measurement result Report.
  • a first sending module configured to: before the network-side device issues the first instruction command, send a beam to the network-side device according to a measurement result Report.
  • the beam report includes at least one of the following information:
  • Antenna panel identification information where the antenna panel identification information corresponds to SSBRI/CRI.
  • the information signal updating apparatus further includes a first measurement module, configured to: in the process of information measurement, after activating the antenna panel that is currently in the deactivated state, perform information measurement, and after the information measurement ends. After that or after sending the beam report, the activated antenna panel is deactivated again.
  • a first measurement module configured to: in the process of information measurement, after activating the antenna panel that is currently in the deactivated state, perform information measurement, and after the information measurement ends. After that or after sending the beam report, the activated antenna panel is deactivated again.
  • the apparatus for updating the information signal in the embodiment of the present application may be an apparatus, an apparatus having an operating system or an electronic device, and may also be a component, an integrated circuit, or a chip in a terminal device.
  • the apparatus or electronic device may be a mobile terminal or a non-mobile terminal.
  • the movable terminal may include, but is not limited to, the types of terminals 101 listed above, and the non-mobile terminal may be a server, a network attached storage (NAS), a personal computer (PC), a television (television, TV), teller machine or self-service machine, etc., which are not specifically limited in the embodiments of the present application.
  • the device for updating the information signal in the embodiment of the present application may be a device having an operating system.
  • the operating system may be an Android (Android) operating system, an IOS operating system, or other possible operating systems, which are not specifically limited in the embodiments of the present application.
  • the apparatus for updating an information signal provided in the embodiment of the present application can implement each process implemented by the method embodiment in FIG. 2 , and achieve the same technical effect. To avoid repetition, details are not described here.
  • This embodiment of the present application further provides a method for updating an information signal, and the method may be executed by a network side device, and the network side device may specifically be the network side device 102 shown in FIG. 1 .
  • the second schematic flowchart of a method for updating an information signal provided by an embodiment of the present application, the method includes:
  • Step 401 the network side device issues a first instruction command, and completes the update of the information signal after the set application time after the first instruction command is issued.
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or is determined by the protocol
  • the agreement is determined according to at least one of the following:
  • the network side device may issue an instruction command to the terminal to indicate that the update needs to be performed and the specific information signal involved in the update.
  • the indication command may be referred to as a first indication command, and a specific information signal to be updated may be indicated by the first indication command.
  • the network-side device can make beam indications for the downlink and uplink channels or reference signals, that is, issue a first indication command for A beam link is established or updated or switched between the network side equipment and the terminal UE to realize the transmission of channels or reference signals.
  • the network-side device After the network-side device issues the first instruction command, the network-side device can determine whether the set application time has reached, and when the set application time has arrived, complete or implement the update of the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, That is, the update of the indicated information signal takes effect.
  • the information signal may be beam information in the beam switching process, may also be the path loss reference signal (Pathloss Reference Signal, PLRS) in the path loss reference signal update process, or may also be the tracking reference signal triggering or configuration or activation process
  • the tracking reference signal (Tracking Reference Signal, TRS) in or may also be other types of reference signals or information, which are not limited in this embodiment of the present application.
  • the above beam information can also be referred to as: spatial relation information, spatial domain transmission filter information, spatial domain reception filter information, and spatial domain filter information. filter) information, Transceiver Configuration Indicator state (Transceiver Configuration Indicator state, TCI state) information, Quasi Co-Location (Quasi Co-Location, QCL) information or QCL parameters, etc.
  • the downlink beam information can usually be represented by TCI state information or QCL information
  • the uplink beam information can usually be represented by TCI state information or spatial relationship information.
  • the set application time is a specific time point after the first instruction command, and the specific time point may be agreed in advance by a protocol or configured by a network side device. Specifically, it can be determined by the network-side device according to at least one of the activation state of the target antenna panel and the capability information of the terminal, for example, only determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel, or only determined according to the capability information of the terminal, or combined with the target antenna
  • the activation state of the panel and the capability information of the terminal are determined; it can also be agreed as a fixed time point by the protocol, that is, a preset fixed constant, or a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel, or a combination of the two.
  • the larger of the preset fixed constant and the value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel may be determined as the set application time.
  • the target antenna panel is one or more antenna panels in the multi-panel terminal, which is the target information signal indicated by the first instruction command or the antenna panel associated with or corresponding to the reference signal in the target information signal.
  • the target antenna panel is the antenna panel to which the network-side device indicates that the beam to be switched to belongs.
  • the antenna panel may also be referred to as: antenna group, antenna port group, antenna set, antenna port set, beam set, beam sub-set, antenna array, antenna port array, antenna sub-array, antenna port sub-array, logical entity, entity or antenna entity, etc.
  • the application time for realizing the update is set, and at the application time , to complete the update of the information signal indicated by the network side, so that the update time of the network side and the UE can be aligned, so that the correct beam link can be maintained and the data transmission performance can be guaranteed.
  • the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first indication command indicates a group of information signals, and there is at least one information signal in the group of information signals or the identification information of the reference signal in the at least one information signal associated with the target antenna panel , determining the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal by using the identification information;
  • the target antenna corresponding to the at least one information signal is determined according to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to at least one information signal included in the first instruction command panel.
  • the embodiment of the present application determines the need to set the application time according to the activation state information of the target antenna panel as a premise, that is, it is necessary to determine one or more applications that need to be applied from multiple antenna panels of the terminal. one antenna panel as the target antenna panel.
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the antenna panel associated with the at least one information signal or the reference signal in the at least one information signal is used as the target antenna panel.
  • the first indication command indicates a group of information signals
  • there is at least one information signal in the group of information signals (or in the first indication command) that corresponds to the identification information of the antenna panel then the at least one information signal is used as the information signal.
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the corresponding antenna panel is used as the target antenna panel.
  • two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined according to the above two methods respectively, and then the final target antenna panel may be determined according to the two groups of candidate target antenna panels.
  • the antenna panels included in the two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined as the final target antenna panels.
  • the identification information of the antenna panel may be: an identification of the antenna panel, a reference signal resource identification, a reference signal resource set identification, a TCI state identification, a QCL information identification or a spatial relationship identification, etc., which are not limited in the embodiments of the present application.
  • the target panel can be determined according to the target panel identification information associated with the TCI status information; or, according to the target panel identification information associated with the reference signal in the TCI status information Determine the target panel; or, the first indication command includes the identification information of the target panel corresponding to the TCI status information, according to which the target panel can be determined.
  • the final target antenna is determined by determining the information signal indicated by the first instruction command or the identification information of the antenna panel associated with the reference signal in the information signal, or the identification information of the antenna panel included in the first instruction command
  • the panel can more accurately update the target information signal.
  • the target antenna panel is determined as follows: there is at least one information signal or at least one information signal in the group of information signals.
  • the reference signal is associated with multiple antenna panel identification information
  • the information signal indicated by the first instruction command or the reference signal in the information signal is associated with multiple antenna panel identification information, and it is necessary to select the corresponding multiple antenna panel identification information according to the situation.
  • the final target antenna panel is determined from the antenna panels.
  • the corresponding antenna panels may be determined directly according to the multiple antenna panel identification information associated with the information signals associated with the multiple antenna panel identification information. Then, multiple antenna panels can be obtained according to the identification information of the multiple antenna panels, so the multiple antenna panels can be determined as the target antenna panels corresponding to the information signal, and there are multiple corresponding target antenna panels.
  • one (or multiple) target antenna panel identification information may also be determined from the plurality of antenna panel identification information according to a preset rule, and the corresponding antenna panel may be used as the target antenna panel. Since there is a correspondence between the identification information of the antenna panel and the antenna panel, this solution can also be understood as determining one (or multiple) as the target antenna panel from the multiple antenna panels corresponding to the multiple antenna panel representation information .
  • the preset rule may be referred to as the first preset rule.
  • the first preset rule includes at least one of the following:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the multiple antenna panel identification information, compare the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values corresponding to the multiple antenna panel identification information respectively, and determining the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information corresponding to the largest one of the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values as the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal;
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the plurality of antenna panel identification information
  • the target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal In the case that the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the plurality of antenna panel identification information, determine the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information arranged in the preset position as the at least one antenna panel The target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal.
  • the L1-RSRP/L1- The SINR value dimension and/or the arrangement position dimension of the antenna panel identification information evaluate the identification information of each antenna panel, determine one (or multiple) antenna panel identification information, and determine its corresponding antenna panel as The target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal associated with the above-mentioned plurality of antenna panel identification information.
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information and the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value corresponding to each antenna panel identification information, then by comparing these L1-RSRP/L1 -SINR value, determine the largest among them, that is, the largest L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value, and determine the antenna panel corresponding to the corresponding antenna panel identification information as the one associated with the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information The target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal.
  • the positions where the identification information of these antenna panels are arranged respectively can be determined, and based on this, the antennas arranged at the preset positions can be determined.
  • Panel identification information so that the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information can be further determined, and determined as the target antenna panel corresponding to the information signals associated with the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information.
  • two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined according to the above two methods respectively, and then the final target antenna panel may be determined according to the two groups of candidate target antenna panels.
  • the antenna panels included in the two groups of candidate target antenna panels may be determined as the final target antenna panels.
  • the CRI corresponds to multiple panel identification information and multiple L1-RSRP values, wherein the panel identification and L1-RSRP values are in one-to-one correspondence.
  • the multiple panel identification information corresponding to the CRI may be used as target panel identification information.
  • determine one (or more) of the multiple panel identification information corresponding to the CRI as the target panel identification information for example, determine the maximum value of the L1-RSRP values corresponding to the multiple panel identification information.
  • the panel identification information corresponding to the L1-RSRP value is determined as the target panel identification information; or, the panel identification information of the plurality of panel identification information arranged at the foremost position in the beam report is used as the target panel identification information.
  • association described in the above embodiment includes at least one of the following:
  • the information signal includes identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the configuration information of the reference signal in the information signal includes identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel or the number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel is included;
  • the network side device indicates that the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the network side device indicates that the reference signal in the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the reference signal in the information signal is determined based on the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device, and the beam report includes SSBRI/CRI and the target antenna panel corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI identification information.
  • the association relationship between the information signal or the reference information in the information signal and the identification information of the target antenna panel in the embodiment of the present application mainly includes the following forms: directly contained (for example, contained in the TCI status information),
  • the configuration/resource set/group/subset/resource to which it belongs includes (for example, in the configuration information resource setting or resource config of the reference signal of the information signal, in the resource set information of the reference signal resource set, the reference signal resource subset resource subset information, in the reference signal group resource group information, in the reference signal resource resource information), the network side device indicates the association and the association through the beam report, etc., which can be specifically represented as at least one of the association relationships listed above.
  • the terminal first reports a beam report to the network side device, and the beam report will include SSBRI/CRI, as well as the identification information of the antenna panel corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI and The L1-RSRP/L1-SINR corresponding to these identification information.
  • the network side device can select the reference signal information corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI according to the antenna panel and its corresponding L1-RSRP/L1-SINR in the beam report, and indicate a group of information signals accordingly.
  • the indicated information signal or the reference signal in the information signal is associated with the based SSBRI/CRI, and further due to the correspondence between the SSBRI/CRI and the identification information of the antenna panel, the indicated information signal or the reference signal in the information signal is generated The relationship between the signal and the identification information of the antenna panel.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first report sent by the terminal to the network-side device includes the activation state information of the target antenna panel, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel according to the first report;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel is included in the beam report sent by the terminal to the network-side device, determine that the activation state of the target antenna panel is the activated state, otherwise, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the activated state is the deactivated state
  • the target antenna panels are multiple target antenna panels, determining the activation states of the multiple target antenna panels according to a second preset rule;
  • the target antenna panel is a plurality of target antenna panels
  • the activation state of the plurality of target antenna panels is self-determined by the terminal.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel can be finally determined according to any one or a combination of any of the above-listed methods for determining the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the UE may send the first report to the network side device to report the activation state of the target antenna panel. That is, the UE may report the first report, and the characteristics of the first report include: the activation state information of the panel, for example, at least one of the activated state, the deactivated state, the downlink-only active state, the uplink-only active state, etc. one.
  • the first report may be different from the beam report, or the same report as the beam report.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel is determined according to whether the identification information of the target antenna panel is included in the beam report. That is, it is determined that the panel corresponding to the panel identification information not included in the beam report is in the deactivated state, and the panel corresponding to the panel identification information included in the beam report is regarded as the active state.
  • the activation state of each target antenna panel is determined by the terminal according to a preset rule or by itself.
  • the terminal can determine the state of the panels corresponding to the multiple panel identification information by itself. Each panel corresponding to the panel identification information is in the active state.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel may be finally determined by combining any of the above determination methods.
  • the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be the active state in various ways is confirmed to be the active state, or the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be in the active state according to various methods is that the number of active states exceeds the set threshold
  • the state is confirmed to be active state, the embodiments of the present application are not limited.
  • the second preset rule includes:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the identification information of the multiple target antenna panels, compare the L1-RSRP/L1- SINR value, and determine the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the first M larger values in the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value as the active state, and determine the L1-RSRP/
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values other than the first M larger values in the L1-SINR value is determined to be a deactivated state, and M is a positive integer;
  • the identification information corresponding to the P target antenna panels arranged in the preset positions will be The antenna panel is determined to be in an active state, and the antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panels except the identification information of the P target antenna panels are determined to be in a deactivated state, and P is a positive integer;
  • a plurality of target antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the plurality of target antenna panels are all determined to be in an active state.
  • the dimension of the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value corresponding to the antenna panel identification information and/or the arrangement position dimension of the antenna panel identification information can be used for each Antenna panel identification information is evaluated to determine the activation status of the corresponding target antenna panel.
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the above-mentioned multiple antenna panel identification information and the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value corresponding to each antenna panel identification information, then by comparing these L1-RSRP/L1 - SINR value, determine the larger M, that is, the first M larger values, and determine the antenna panels corresponding to the antenna panel identification information corresponding to the first M larger values as the active state. For other L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values except the first M larger values among these L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values, the antenna panel identification information corresponding to the other L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values respectively corresponds to The antenna panel is determined to be deactivated.
  • the positions where these antenna panel identification information are arranged respectively can be determined, and based on this, the P The identification information of the P antenna panels can be further determined, and the P target antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the P antenna panels can be further determined, and the activation state of the P target antenna panels can be determined as the activated state.
  • Target antenna panels other than the P target antenna panels are determined to be in a deactivated state.
  • the target antenna panels corresponding to the above-mentioned identification information of the plurality of target antenna panels are all determined to be in the active state.
  • the CRI corresponds to multiple panel identification information and multiple L1-RSRP values, wherein the panel identification and the L1-RSRP value are in one-to-one correspondence. If the TCI status information indicated by the first indication command is determined according to the CRI, then multiple L1-RSRP values corresponding to the CRI can be compared, arranged from large to small, and the panel identification information corresponding to the first M large values can be The panel is determined as the activated state, and the rest of the panels are determined as the deactivated state.
  • the panels corresponding to the P pieces of panel identification information that are arranged at the foremost positions in the beam report corresponding to the multiple panel identification information corresponding to the CRI are determined to be in an active state, and the remaining panels are determined to be in a deactivated state.
  • the panels corresponding to the plurality of panel identification information corresponding to the CRI are all determined to be in the active state.
  • the activation states of the corresponding two or three groups of target antenna panels to be confirmed according to any two or three of the above three methods, and then according to the two or three groups of target antennas to be confirmed. Panel activation state, and finally determine the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be the active state in various ways is confirmed to be the active state, or the state of the target antenna panel that is determined to be in the active state according to various methods is that the number of active states exceeds the set threshold
  • the state is confirmed to be active state, the embodiments of the present application are not limited.
  • the UE may deactivate the panel considered to be in the deactivated state according to the above rules.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is:
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the first preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel The duration of the activation delay, or, a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the information signal is specifically beam information, path loss reference signal PLRS or tracking reference signal TRS
  • when there is at least one information signal in a group of information signals indicated by the first indication information When the target antenna panel corresponding to the target antenna panel identification information associated with the information signal or the reference signal of the at least one information signal is in the deactivated state, it is necessary to delay the first preset time period on the basis of the application time agreed in the existing protocol, Finally, the application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is obtained, that is, the application time is set.
  • the network side device may first use the first instruction command to indicate a group of TCI states, wherein the first instruction command indicates a group of TCI states, which may be a MAC CE command to activate a group of TCI states, or DCI to indicate a group of TCI states, And a set of TCI states includes at least one TCI state.
  • the beam application time (beam application time, BAT) is the first preset time + the first preset duration.
  • the first preset time may be the application time in the existing protocol, such as the beam application time of the existing protocol, which is usually a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the first preset duration is an additional delay related to the activation state of the target antenna panel, which may be a duration configured by the network-side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the activation delay of the antenna panel, or, based on the agreement of the protocol. The value determined by the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the application time corresponding to the at least one information signal described above, that is, the set application time may be any of the following:
  • the first preset time may be X ms, Y symbol or Z slot after the first indication command or the ACK transmission time of the first indication command, and the first preset time may be based on the UE capability reported by the UE. ) to determine that the duration satisfies the duration required for panel activation.
  • the set application time corresponding to the beam information is the ACK time of the MAC CE + 3ms + target antenna panel activation delay.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is: a first preset time; wherein the first preset time The time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time calculated according to the above embodiment no longer includes the activation process of the target antenna panel. the first preset duration. That is to say, if the set of TCI states is associated with an activated panel, or if the reference signals in the set of TCI states are associated with an activated panel, the application time is set when the above-mentioned target antenna panel is in the deactivated state The included first preset duration is no longer required.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time corresponding to the activated state of the target antenna panel may also be the application time in the existing protocol, such as
  • the beam application time of the existing protocol is usually a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the reference signal of the TCI state exists according to the deactivated state
  • the first preset duration in the application time corresponding to the TCI state in the above-mentioned embodiment is required; in the group of TCI states, the existence of the reference signal of the TCI state is based on
  • the first preset duration in the application time corresponding to the TCI state in the above embodiment is no longer required.
  • the set application time is always the first preset as agreed by the protocol or configured by the network side device. time + first preset duration, or, first preset duration; wherein, the first preset duration is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network-side device, and the first preset duration is
  • the network-side device is configured according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel activation time delay, or is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the UE may determine the activation state of the panel corresponding to the multiple panel identification information by itself.
  • the network-side device cannot know the activation state of the panel, and can always use one of the following as the set application time:
  • the first preset time and the first preset duration may be the same as those in the above-mentioned embodiments, which will not be repeated here.
  • the set application time is fixed by the agreement as the first preset time + the first preset duration, or, it is the first preset time; wherein, the first preset time is the fixed time agreed in the agreement. value, the first preset duration is agreed by the protocol as a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel may not be considered, and the set application time is always set as a specific time. like:
  • the first preset time and the first preset duration may be the same as those in the above-mentioned embodiments, which will not be repeated here.
  • the first preset time in the application time corresponding to the PLRS may be the application time agreed in the existing protocol+N samples.
  • the UE can track/measure a set of TCI states, or track/measure the reference signal in each TCI state in a set of TCI states.
  • the set application time is the first time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • Application time, the first application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset time
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • pathloss RS pathloss RS
  • PLRS path loss reference signal
  • its application time can be determined according to the state of the panel associated with the PLRS, which can be referred to as the first application time to distinguish it from the general set application time in the above embodiment.
  • the first application time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated can use the application time in the existing protocol + the third preset time length, such as the ACK time of the MAC CE command + 3ms (+N samples)+the third preset duration.
  • the application time in the existing protocol may be used as the second preset time.
  • the second preset time may be the same as the first preset time in the foregoing embodiments, or may also be the first preset time+N samples.
  • the third preset duration may be the same as the first preset duration in the foregoing embodiments.
  • the second preset time may be a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is the time length configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the activation delay of the antenna panel, or
  • the value agreed by the protocol is determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or a value determined based on the capability information of the terminal.
  • the set application time is the second application corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • the second application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or determined based on the capability information of the terminal value.
  • the third preset duration in the above embodiment is no longer required. That is, if the panel associated with the updated PLRS is in the active state, the application time in the existing protocol is used as the first application time of the corresponding PLRS, such as the ACK time+3ms of the MAC CE command, or the ACK time+3ms+N sample.
  • the second preset time may be one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the second preset time independent of the state of the target antenna panel may be the above-mentioned embodiment. any of the listed.
  • the set application time is a third application time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated, and the third application time is fixed to one of the following: :
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the application time corresponding to the PLRS can also be directly stipulated by the protocol or configured by the network side device without considering the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the application time of the PLRS can always be confirmed as the application time in the existing protocol + the third preset duration, such as the ACK time of the MAC CE command + 3ms (+N samples) + the third preset duration, Alternatively, always confirm the application time of the PLRS as the application time in the existing protocol, such as the ACK time of the MAC CE command + 3ms (+N samples).
  • the application time of the PLRS may always be the same as the application time BAT of the beam information, or it may always be the above-mentioned BAT+N samples.
  • N depends on UE capability, or N is a fixed value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the target antenna panel is in the active state and the embodiment in which the target antenna panel is in the deactivated state in the above-mentioned PLRS embodiment, it is possible to set the application time and the target antenna through a protocol agreement or network side device configuration.
  • the second preset time independent of the state of the panel may be any of those listed above.
  • the method for updating an information signal further includes: the network side device delivering a second indication command to the terminal, where the second indication command indicates a group of path loss reference signals; Then, in the case where at least one path loss reference signal in the set of path loss reference signals is a reference signal in any TCI state in a set of TCI states indicated by the first indication command, the at least one path loss reference signal is The application time corresponding to the loss reference signal is the set application time corresponding to any one TCI state, or, the set application time corresponding to the any one TCI state+N samples; wherein, N is The protocol agreement or a preset constant configured by the network side device or a value determined based on capability information of the terminal.
  • the network side device can issue a second instruction command to the terminal, and indicate a group of PLRS through the second instruction command, and then it can be judged whether the PLRS is not. It is a reference signal in a group of TCI states indicated in advance by the network side device, if there is at least one PLRS that is a reference signal in any TCI state in this group of TCI states, then the application time corresponding to the at least one PLRS is determined as the The set application time corresponding to any one TCI state, or, the set application time corresponding to any one TCI state + N samples.
  • any PLRS in a group of PLRSs is a reference signal in a TCI state in a group of TCI states
  • the application time corresponding to the PLRS is the same as the BAT in the above-mentioned embodiments or BAT+N samples.
  • any path loss reference signal in the set of path loss reference signals is not a reference signal included in any TCI state in the set of TCI states, then the application corresponding to any path loss reference signal The time is one of the following:
  • the third preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the third preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the reference signal in the state if there is any PLRS that is not the reference signal in any TCI state in the group of TCI states, then the application time corresponding to any PLRS is determined as: the application time in the existing protocol, or , the application time in the existing protocol + the third preset time length, or the BAT in the above-mentioned embodiments, or the BAT+N sample in the above-mentioned embodiments, or the BAT+N sample+ in the above-mentioned embodiments.
  • the third preset duration determines the application time according to the state of the panel associated with the PLRS, and specifically includes any one of the above listed application times.
  • the third preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the third preset time independent of the activation state of the panel that can be agreed by the protocol or configured by the network side device is any one of the above listed application times.
  • the information signal is a tracking reference signal TRS
  • the TRS indicated by the first indication command is a periodic or semi-persistent TRS
  • the first preset corresponding to the periodic or semi-persistent TRS The time is: the transmission time of the periodic or semi-persistent TRS configured by the network side device.
  • the information signal in the above-mentioned embodiment is a tracking reference signal TRS
  • the TRS is a periodic or semi-persistent TRS
  • the first preset time in the above-mentioned embodiment is the periodic or semi-continuous TRS in the existing protocol.
  • the transmission time of the continuous TRS may specifically be the period or the transmission time of the semi-persistent TRS configured by the network side device. Wherein, the transmission time is determined according to the period value and the offset value of the period or semi-persistent TRS transmission configured by the network side device.
  • the first preset time length needs to be added, and if the panel is activated, the first preset time length does not need to be added. Set the duration.
  • the network-side device uses RRC signaling to configure the transmission time information (period value and time offset value) of the periodic TRS.
  • the time is 1ms, 6ms, 11ms... . If the corresponding target antenna panel is in the deactivated state and the activation delay of the antenna panel is 8ms, the actual transmission time of the TRS needs to delay the original transmission time by the activation delay of the antenna panel, that is, the setting application of the period TRS
  • the time is 1ms+8ms, 6ms+8ms, 11ms+8ms..., that is, 9ms, 14ms, 19ms... .
  • the first preset time is 1ms, 6ms, 11ms...
  • the first preset duration is 8ms. If the target antenna panel corresponding to the TRS is in the active state, that is, the TRS is measured by the terminal using the target antenna panel in the active state, the first preset duration in the above set application time is no longer required, that is, the period of the TRS Set the application time to 1ms, 6ms, 11ms... .
  • the network side device uses the first indication command to trigger the aperiodic TRS, and the specific setting and application time is the same as that of beam switching and PLRS updating.
  • the network side device when the network side device triggers or configures or activates the TRS using the first instruction command, it can determine the application time of the TRS (such as the transmission time or the time when the UE measures the TRS) according to the panel state associated with the TRS as one of the following: :
  • the first preset time after the first instruction command if the target antenna panel corresponding to the TRS is an inactive panel, the first preset time length needs to be added, and if it is an activated panel, it is not necessary to add;
  • the first preset time after the ACK transmission time of the first indication command. If the target antenna panel corresponding to the TRS is an inactive panel, the first preset time length needs to be added.
  • the transmission time of the TRS, or the transmission time of the TRS + the first preset duration is always used.
  • the panel state can be determined according to the measurement results of the TRS corresponding to different panel identification information (such as the size of the measurement value, etc.), or the UE can determine the panel state by itself; and then according to the panel state , to determine the transmission time of the TRS or the time for the UE to measure the TRS.
  • the method further includes: the network-side device receiving a beam report, the beam report being that the terminal reports to the Reported by the device on the network side.
  • the embodiment of the present application can be understood that, before the network side device issues the first instruction command to indicate the specific information signal to be updated, the terminal can first measure the beam information, and measure the beam information according to the measurement result. , generate a corresponding beam report and report it to the network side device. The corresponding network side device can receive the beam report.
  • the network-side device may issue a first instruction command according to the beam report reported by the terminal, indicating a group of beam information to be updated.
  • the network side device can configure a reference signal resource set (RS resource set) in the reference signal resource configuration (RS resource config, or RS resource setting), which includes at least one reference signal resource, such as SSB resource or CSI-RS resource.
  • the UE measures the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR of each RS resource, and reports the optimal at least one measurement result to the network.
  • the reported content may include, for example, SSBRI or CRI and its corresponding L1-RSRP/L1-SINR.
  • the panel identification information used for each L1-RSRP/L1-SINR measurement result corresponding to each SSRBI/CRI may also be reported.
  • the beam report includes at least one of the following information:
  • Antenna panel identification information where the antenna panel identification information corresponds to SSBRI/CRI.
  • the above-mentioned beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device may selectively include any one or a combination of any of the above-mentioned contents. For example, only include SSBRI/CRI and L1-RSRP/L1-SINR corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI, or only include the antenna panel identification information, or include both SSBRI/CRI and the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI SINR, and antenna panel identification information.
  • the antenna panel identification information may correspond to the SSBRI/CRI, that is, each SSBRI/CRI in the beam report has one or more corresponding antenna panel identification information, and the antenna panel identification information corresponding to different SSBRIs/CRIs may be the same or different.
  • the execution subject may be an information signal updating apparatus, or, in the information signal updating apparatus, the updating method for loading the network side information signals may be performed.
  • the method's control module In this embodiment of the present application, the method for updating an information signal on the network side performed by an apparatus for updating an information signal is taken as an example to describe the apparatus for updating an information signal provided by the embodiment of the present application.
  • FIG. 5 is the second schematic diagram of the structure of the information signal updating apparatus provided in the embodiment of the present application.
  • the updating of the information signal in the embodiment of the updating method of the information signal, the device includes:
  • the second processing module 501 is configured to issue a first instruction command, and complete the update of the information signal at a set application time after the first instruction command is issued;
  • the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command
  • the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or is determined by the agreement according to the Determine at least one of the following:
  • the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first indication command indicates a group of information signals, and there is at least one information signal in the group of information signals or the identification information of the reference signal in the at least one information signal associated with the target antenna panel , determining the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal by using the identification information;
  • the target antenna corresponding to the at least one information signal is determined according to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to at least one information signal included in the first instruction command panel.
  • the target antenna panel is determined as follows:
  • At least one information signal in the group of information signals or a reference signal in at least one information signal is associated with multiple antenna panel identification information
  • the first preset rule includes at least one of the following:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device includes the multiple antenna panel identification information, compare the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values corresponding to the multiple antenna panel identification information respectively, and determining the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information corresponding to the largest one of the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values as the target antenna panel corresponding to the at least one information signal;
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the plurality of antenna panel identification information
  • the target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal In the case that the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the plurality of antenna panel identification information, determine the antenna panel corresponding to the antenna panel identification information arranged in the preset position as the at least one antenna panel The target antenna panel corresponding to the information signal.
  • the activation state of the target antenna panel is determined in at least one of the following ways:
  • the first report sent by the terminal to the network-side device includes the activation state information of the target antenna panel, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel according to the first report;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel is included in the beam report sent by the terminal to the network-side device, determine that the activation state of the target antenna panel is the activated state, otherwise, determine the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the activated state is the deactivated state
  • the target antenna panels are multiple target antenna panels, determining the activation states of the multiple target antenna panels according to a second preset rule;
  • the target antenna panel is a plurality of target antenna panels
  • the activation state of the plurality of target antenna panels is self-determined by the terminal.
  • the second preset rule includes:
  • the beam report reported by the terminal to the network-side device includes the identification information of the multiple target antenna panels, compare the L1-RSRP/L1- SINR value, and determine the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the first M larger values in the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR value as the active state, and determine the L1-RSRP/
  • the antenna panel corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel corresponding to the L1-RSRP/L1-SINR values other than the first M larger values in the L1-SINR value is determined to be a deactivated state, and M is a positive integer;
  • the identification information corresponding to the P target antenna panels arranged in the preset positions will be The antenna panel is determined to be in an active state, and the antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panels except the identification information of the P target antenna panels are determined to be in a deactivated state, and P is a positive integer;
  • a plurality of target antenna panels corresponding to the identification information of the plurality of target antenna panels are all determined to be in an active state.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is:
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the first preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel The duration of the activation delay, or, a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time corresponding to the at least one information signal is:
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in a protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the first preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time is always the first preset as agreed by the protocol or configured by the network side device. time + the first preset duration, or, the first preset time;
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the first preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel The duration of the activation delay, or, a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the set application time is fixed by the agreement as the first preset time + the first preset duration, or, the first preset time;
  • the first preset time is a fixed value agreed in the agreement
  • the first preset time length is agreed in the agreement as a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • the set application time is the first time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • Application time, the first application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset time
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time is the second application corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated.
  • the second application time is one of the following:
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or determined based on the capability information of the terminal value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the set application time is a third application time corresponding to the path loss reference signal to be updated, and the third application time is fixed to one of the following: :
  • the second preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the second preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device
  • the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the second preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the method for updating an information signal further includes: the network side device delivering a second indication command to the terminal, where the second indication command indicates a group of path loss reference signals;
  • the at least one path loss reference signal in the set of path loss reference signals is a reference signal in any TCI state in a set of TCI states indicated by the first indication command
  • the at least one path loss reference signal is The application time corresponding to the loss reference signal is the set application time corresponding to any one of the TCI states, or, the set application time+N samples corresponding to the any one of the TCI states;
  • N is a protocol agreement or a preset constant configured by the network side device, or a value determined based on capability information of the terminal.
  • any path loss reference signal in the set of path loss reference signals is not a reference signal included in any TCI state in the set of TCI states, then the application corresponding to any path loss reference signal The time is one of the following:
  • the third preset time + N samples + the third preset duration
  • the third preset time is a fixed value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, and the third preset time length is configured by the network side device according to the capability information of the terminal to satisfy the antenna panel
  • the duration of the activation delay or, it is a value agreed by the protocol as determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel
  • N is a preset constant agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device, or based on the capability information of the terminal determined value.
  • the third preset time is one of the following:
  • the second preset duration is a preset value agreed in the protocol or configured by the network side device.
  • the information signal is a tracking reference signal TRS
  • the TRS indicated by the first indication command is a periodic or semi-persistent TRS
  • the first preset corresponding to the periodic or semi-persistent TRS The times are:
  • the transmission time of the periodic or semi-persistent TRS configured by the network side device is configured by the network side device.
  • the association includes at least one of the following:
  • the information signal includes identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the configuration information of the reference signal in the information signal includes the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the identification information of the target antenna panel or the number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel is included;
  • the network side device indicates that the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the network side device indicates that the reference signal in the information signal is associated with the identification information of the target antenna panel or a number corresponding to the identification information of the target antenna panel;
  • the reference signal in the information signal is determined based on the beam report reported by the terminal to the network side device, and the beam report includes SSBRI/CRI and the target antenna panel corresponding to the SSBRI/CRI identification information.
  • a receiving module configured to receive a beam report before the network side device issues the first instruction command, where the beam report is reported by the terminal to the network side device according to the measurement result.
  • the beam report includes at least one of the following information:
  • Antenna panel identification information where the antenna panel identification information corresponds to SSBRI/CRI.
  • the apparatus for updating the information signal in the embodiment of the present application may be an apparatus, an apparatus having an operating system or an electronic device, and may also be a component, an integrated circuit, or a chip in a network-side device.
  • the apparatus or electronic device may include, but is not limited to, the types of the network side device 102 listed above, which are not specifically limited in this embodiment of the present application.
  • the device for updating the information signal in the embodiment of the present application may be a device having an operating system.
  • the operating system may be an Android (Android) operating system, an IOS operating system, or other possible operating systems, which are not specifically limited in the embodiments of the present application.
  • the apparatus for updating an information signal provided in this embodiment of the present application can implement each process implemented by the method embodiment in FIG. 4 , and achieve the same technical effect. To avoid repetition, details are not repeated here.
  • an embodiment of the present application further provides a communication device 600 , including a processor 601 , a memory 602 , and programs or instructions stored in the memory 602 and running on the processor 601 .
  • the communication device may be a terminal or a network-side device.
  • the communication device 600 is a terminal
  • the program or instruction is executed by the processor 601
  • each process of the above-mentioned embodiment of the method for updating the information signal of the terminal can be achieved, and can achieve The same technical effect.
  • the communication device 600 is a network-side device
  • the program or instruction is executed by the processor 601
  • each process of the above-mentioned embodiment of the method for updating the information signal of the network-side device can be realized, and the same technical effect can be achieved. In order to avoid repetition, I won't go into details here.
  • An embodiment of the present application further provides a terminal, including a processor and a communication interface, wherein the processor is configured to complete the update of the information signal by setting the application time after the network side device issues the first instruction command; wherein , the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal, or, by The protocol agreement is determined according to at least one of the following: a preset fixed constant; a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • This terminal embodiment corresponds to the above-mentioned terminal-side method embodiment, and each implementation process and implementation manner of the above-mentioned method embodiment can be applied to this terminal embodiment, and can achieve the same technical effect.
  • FIG. 7 is a schematic diagram of a hardware structure of a terminal implementing an embodiment of the present application.
  • the terminal 700 includes but is not limited to: a radio frequency unit 701, a network module 702, an audio output unit 703, an input unit 704, a sensor 705, a display unit 706, a user input unit 707, an interface unit 708, a memory 709, and a processor 710, etc. at least part of the components.
  • the terminal 700 may also include a power source (such as a battery) for supplying power to various components, and the power source may be logically connected to the processor 710 through a power management system, so as to manage charging, discharging, and power consumption through the power management system management and other functions.
  • a power source such as a battery
  • the terminal structure shown in FIG. 7 does not constitute a limitation on the terminal, and the terminal may include more or less components than shown, or combine some components, or arrange different components, which will not be repeated here.
  • the input unit 704 may include a graphics processor (Graphics Processing Unit, GPU) 7041 and a microphone 7042. Such as camera) to obtain still pictures or video image data for processing.
  • the display unit 706 may include a display panel 7061, which may be configured in the form of a liquid crystal display, an organic light emitting diode, or the like.
  • the user input unit 707 includes a touch panel 7071 and other input devices 7072 .
  • the touch panel 7071 is also called a touch screen.
  • the touch panel 7071 may include two parts, a touch detection device and a touch controller.
  • Other input devices 7072 may include, but are not limited to, physical keyboards, function keys (such as volume control keys, switch keys, etc.), trackballs, mice, and joysticks, which will not be repeated here.
  • the radio frequency unit 701 receives the downlink data from the network side device, and then processes it to the processor 710; in addition, sends the uplink data to the network side device.
  • the radio frequency unit 701 includes, but is not limited to, an antenna, at least one amplifier, a transceiver, a coupler, a low noise amplifier, a duplexer, and the like.
  • Memory 709 may be used to store software programs or instructions as well as various data.
  • the memory 709 may mainly include a storage program or instruction area and a storage data area, wherein the storage program or instruction area may store an operating system, an application program or instruction required for at least one function (such as a sound playback function, an image playback function, etc.) and the like.
  • the memory 709 may include a high-speed random access memory, and may also include a non-volatile memory, wherein the non-volatile memory may be a read-only memory (Read-Only Memory, ROM), a programmable read-only memory (Programmable ROM) , PROM), erasable programmable read-only memory (Erasable PROM, EPROM), electrically erasable programmable read-only memory (Electrically EPROM, EEPROM) or flash memory.
  • ROM Read-Only Memory
  • PROM programmable read-only memory
  • PROM erasable programmable read-only memory
  • Erasable PROM Erasable PROM
  • EPROM electrically erasable programmable read-only memory
  • EEPROM electrically erasable programmable read-only memory
  • flash memory for example at least one magnetic disk storage device, flash memory device, or other non-volatile solid state storage device.
  • the processor 710 may include one or more processing units; optionally, the processor 710 may integrate an application processor and a modem processor, wherein the application processor mainly processes the operating system, user interface, application programs or instructions, etc., Modem processors mainly deal with wireless communications, such as baseband processors. It can be understood that, the above-mentioned modulation and demodulation processor may not be integrated into the processor 710.
  • the processor 710 is configured to set the application time after the network side device sends the first instruction command to complete the update of the information signal.
  • the application time for realizing the update is set according to the determined activation state of the target antenna panel, and the network side completes the application time at the application time.
  • the update of the indicated information signal can align the update time of the network side and the UE, so that the correct beam link can be maintained and the data transmission performance can be guaranteed.
  • the radio frequency unit 701 is configured to receive a second indication command sent by the network side device, where the second indication command indicates a group of path loss reference signals.
  • the radio frequency unit 701 is further configured to send a beam report to the network side device according to the measurement result.
  • the processor 710 is further configured to perform information measurement after activating the antenna panel that is currently in the deactivated state during the information measurement process, and after the information measurement is completed or after the beam report is sent, the information is measured. The activated antenna panel is then deactivated.
  • the deactivated antenna panel is activated during the information measurement process, and the antenna panel is deactivated after the measurement, which can effectively save energy and improve overall efficiency.
  • An embodiment of the present application further provides a network-side device, including a processor and a communication interface, where the processor is configured to issue a first instruction command, and set an application time after the first instruction command is issued, and complete the information signal wherein, the information signal is the information signal indicated by the first instruction command, and the set application time is determined by the network-side device according to the activation state of the target antenna panel and/or the capability information of the terminal , or, determined by the agreement according to at least one of the following: a preset fixed constant; a value determined according to the activation state of the target antenna panel.
  • This network-side device embodiment corresponds to the above-mentioned network-side device method embodiment, and each implementation process and implementation manner of the above-mentioned method embodiment can be applied to this network-side device embodiment, and can achieve the same technical effect.
  • FIG. 8 is a schematic diagram of the hardware structure of a network side device implementing an embodiment of the present application. As shown in FIG. The antenna 801 is connected to the radio frequency device 802 .
  • the radio frequency device 802 receives information through the antenna 801, and sends the received information to the baseband device 803 for processing.
  • the baseband device 803 processes the information to be sent and sends it to the radio frequency device 802
  • the radio frequency device 802 processes the received information and sends it out through the antenna 801 .
  • the structure of the network-side device shown in FIG. 8 does not constitute a limitation on the network-side device of the present application, and the network-side device of the present application may include more or less components than those shown in the figure, or a combination of certain components may be included. Some components, or different component arrangements, will not be repeated here.
  • the baseband apparatus 803 may include a frequency band processing apparatus, and the method performed by the network side device in the above embodiments may be implemented in the baseband apparatus 803 , where the baseband apparatus 803 includes a processor 804 and a memory 805 .
  • the baseband device 803 may include, for example, at least one baseband board on which multiple chips are arranged. As shown in FIG. 8 , one of the chips is, for example, the processor 804 , which is connected to the memory 805 to call the program in the memory 805 to execute The operations of the network side device shown in the above method embodiments.
  • the baseband device 803 may further include a network interface 806 for exchanging information with the radio frequency device 802, and the interface is, for example, a common public radio interface (CPRI for short).
  • CPRI common public radio interface
  • the network-side device in this embodiment of the present invention further includes: an instruction or program stored in the memory 805 and executable on the processor 804, and the processor 804 invokes the instruction or program in the memory 805 to execute the network in the above embodiments.
  • the update method of the information signal performed by the side device side achieves the same technical effect, so it is not repeated here in order to avoid repetition.
  • Embodiments of the present application further provide a readable storage medium, where a program or an instruction is stored on the readable storage medium, and when the program or instruction is executed by a processor, each process of the above-mentioned embodiment of the method for updating an information signal is implemented, and can To achieve the same technical effect, in order to avoid repetition, details are not repeated here.
  • the processor is the processor in the terminal or the network side device described in the foregoing embodiment.
  • the readable storage medium includes a computer-readable storage medium, such as a computer read-only memory (Read-Only Memory, ROM), a random access memory (Random Access Memory, RAM), a magnetic disk or an optical disk, and the like.
  • An embodiment of the present application further provides a chip, the chip includes a processor and a communication interface, the communication interface is coupled to the processor, and the processor is used for running a program or an instruction to implement the above method for updating information signals In order to avoid repetition, the details are not repeated here.
  • the chip mentioned in the embodiments of the present application may also be referred to as a system-on-chip, a system-on-chip, a system-on-chip, or a system-on-a-chip, or the like.
  • Embodiments of the present application further provide a computer program/program product, where the computer program/program product is stored in a non-transitory storage medium, and the program/program product is executed by at least one processor to realize the above-mentioned information signal
  • the embodiment of the update method of the 10000 can achieve the same technical effect, and in order to avoid repetition, it is not repeated here.

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
  • Signal Processing (AREA)
  • Quality & Reliability (AREA)
  • Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)

Abstract

本申请公开了一种信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备,属于通信技术领域,本申请实施例的信息信号的更新方法包括:终端在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成信息信号的更新;其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:预设固定常量;根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。

Description

信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备
相关申请的交叉引用
本申请要求于2021年4月12日提交的申请号为2021103905458,发明名称为“信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备”的中国专利申请的优先权,其通过引用方式全部并入本申请。
技术领域
本申请属于通信技术领域,具体涉及一种信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备。
背景技术
目前,对于多面板终端(multi-panel User Equipment,MPUE),当网络指示UE进行波束(beam)切换等的信息信号更新时,尤其是在多个天线面板(panel)上进行beam切换时,常常由于网络与UE之间的beam切换时间不能对齐,导致波束链路发生错误,并进一步导致数据传输失败或性能损失。
发明内容
本申请实施例提供一种信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备,能够解决由于UE与网络侧切换时间不能对齐导致的数据传输失败或性能损失问题。
第一方面,提供了一种信息信号的更新方法,该方法包括:
终端在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设 定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
第二方面,提供了一种信息信号的更新装置,包括:
第一处理模块,用于在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
第三方面,提供了一种信息信号的更新方法,应用于网络侧设备,该方法包括:
网络侧设备下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
第四方面,提供了一种信息信号的更新装置,包括:
第二处理模块,用于下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
第五方面,提供了一种终端,该终端包括处理器、存储器及存储在所述存储器上并可在所述处理器上运行的程序或指令,所述程序或指令被所述处理器执行时实现如第一方面所述的方法的步骤。
第六方面,提供了一种终端,包括处理器及通信接口,其中,所述处理器用于在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
第七方面,提供了一种网络侧设备,该网络侧设备包括处理器、存储器及存储在所述存储器上并可在所述处理器上运行的程序或指令,所述程序或指令被所述处理器执行时实现如第三方面所述的方法的步骤。
第八方面,提供了一种网络侧设备,包括处理器及通信接口,其中,所述处理器用于下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
第九方面,提供了一种可读存储介质,所述可读存储介质上存储程序或指令,所述程序或指令被处理器执行时实现如第一方面所述的方法的步骤,或者实现如第三方面所述的方法的步骤。
第十方面,提供了一种芯片,所述芯片包括处理器和通信接口,所述通信接口和所述处理器耦合,所述处理器用于运行程序或指令,实现如第一方面所述的方法,或实现如第三方面所述的方法。
第十一方面,提供了一种计算机程序/程序产品,所述计算机程序/程序产品被存储在非瞬态的存储介质中,所述程序/程序产品被至少一个处理器执行以实现如第一方面所述的方法的步骤,或者实现如第三方面所述的方法的步骤。
在本申请实施例中,在网络侧设备通过指示命令指示了信息信号的更新的情况下,根据确定的目标天线面板的激活状态,设定实现更新的应用时间,并在该应用时间,完成网络侧指示的信息信号的更新,能够使网络侧和UE的更新时间对齐,从而可以维持正确的波束链路,保证数据传输性能。
附图说明
图1为本申请实施例可应用的一种无线通信系统的结构图;
图2为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新方法的流程示意图之一;
图3为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置的结构示意图之一;
图4为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新方法的流程示意图之二;
图5为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置的结构示意图之二;
图6为本申请实施例提供的通信设备的结构示意图;
图7为实现本申请实施例的终端的硬件结构示意图;
图8为实现本申请实施例的网络侧设备的硬件结构示意图。
具体实施方式
下面将结合本申请实施例中的附图,对本申请实施例中的技术方案进行清楚描述,显然,所描述的实施例是本申请一部分实施例,而不是全部的实施例。基于本申请中的实施例,本领域普通技术人员所获得的所有其他实施例,都属于本申请保护的范围。
本申请的说明书和权利要求书中的术语“第一”、“第二”等是用于区别类似的对象,而不用于描述特定的顺序或先后次序。应该理解这样使用的术语在适当情况下可以互换,以便本申请的实施例能够以除了在这里图示或描述的那些以外的顺序实施,且“第一”、“第二”所区别的对象通常为一类,并不限定对象的个数,例如第一对象可以是一个,也可以是多个。此外,说明书以及权利要求中“和/或”表示所连接对象的至少其中之一,字符“/”一般表示前后关联对象是一种“或”的关系。
值得指出的是,本申请实施例所描述的技术不限于长期演进型(Long Term Evolution,LTE)/LTE的演进(LTE-Advanced,LTE-A)系统,还可用于其他无线通信系统,诸如码分多址(Code Division Multiple Access,CDMA)、时分多址(Time Division Multiple Access,TDMA)、频分多址(Frequency Division Multiple Access,FDMA)、正交频分多址(Orthogonal Frequency Division Multiple Access,OFDMA)、单载波频分多址(Single-carrier Frequency-Division Multiple Access,SC-FDMA)和其他系统。本申请实施例中的术语“系统”和“网络”常被可互换地使用,所描述的技术既可用于以上提及的系统和无线电技术,也可用于其他系统和无线电技术。以下描述出于示例目的描述了新空口(New Radio,NR)系统,并且在以下大部分描述中使用NR术语,但是这些技术也可应用于NR系统应用以外的应用,如第6代(6 th Generation,6G)通信系统。
图1示出本申请实施例可应用的一种无线通信系统的结构图。无线 通信系统包括终端101和网络侧设备102。其中,终端101也可以称作终端设备或者用户终端(User Equipment,UE),终端101可以是手机、平板电脑(Tablet Personal Computer)、膝上型电脑(Laptop Computer)或称为笔记本电脑、个人数字助理(Personal Digital Assistant,PDA)、掌上电脑、上网本、超级移动个人计算机(ultra-mobile personal computer,UMPC)、移动上网装置(Mobile Internet Device,MID)、可穿戴式设备(Wearable Device)或车载设备(VUE)、行人终端(PUE)等终端侧设备,可穿戴式设备包括:智能手表、手环、耳机、眼镜等。需要说明的是,在本申请实施例并不限定终端101的具体类型。网络侧设备102可以是基站或核心网,其中,基站可被称为节点B、演进节点B、接入点、基收发机站(Base Transceiver Station,BTS)、无线电基站、无线电收发机、基本服务集(Basic Service Set,BSS)、扩展服务集(Extended Service Set,ESS)、B节点、演进型B节点(eNB)、家用B节点、家用演进型B节点、WLAN接入点、WiFi节点、发送接收点(Transmitting Receiving Point,TRP)或所述领域中其他某个合适的术语,只要达到相同的技术效果,所述基站不限于特定技术词汇,需要说明的是,在本申请实施例中仅以NR系统中的基站为例,但是并不限定基站的具体类型。核心网设备可以包含但不限于如下至少一项:核心网节点、核心网功能、移动管理实体(Mobility Management Entity,MME)、接入移动管理功能(Access and Mobility Management Function,AMF)、会话管理功能(Session Management Function,SMF)、用户平面功能(User Plane Function,UPF)、策略控制功能(Policy Control Function,PCF)、策略与计费规则功能单元(Policy and Charging Rules Function,PCRF)、边缘应用服务发现功能(Edge Application Server Discovery Function,EASDF)、统一数据管理(Unified Data Management,UDM),统一数据仓储(Unified Data Repository,UDR)、归属用户服务器(Home Subscriber Server,HSS)、集中式网络配置(Centralized network  configuration,CNC)、网络存储功能(Network Repository Function,NRF),网络开放功能(Network Exposure Function,NEF)、本地NEF(Local NEF,或L-NEF)、绑定支持功能(Binding Support Function,BSF)、应用功能(Application Function,AF)等。需要说明的是,在本申请实施例中仅以NR系统中的核心网设备为例进行介绍,并不限定核心网设备的具体类型。
下面结合附图,通过一些实施例及其应用场景对本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备进行详细地说明。
图2为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新方法的流程示意图之一,该方法可由终端执行,该终端具体可以是图1中示出的终端101。如图2所示,该方法包括:
步骤201,终端在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新。
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
具体而言,在需要对网络连接中的信息信号进行更新时,网络侧设备可以向终端下发指示命令,以指示需要进行更新以及更新所涉及的具体信息信号。为便于区分,其中的指示命令可称为是第一指示命令,且可以通过该第一指示命令,指示具体的需更新的信息信号。
例如,在波束切换的场景中,在经过UE的波束测量和波束报告后,网络侧设备可以对下行与上行链路的信道或参考信号做波束指示,也即下发第一指示命令,用于在网络侧设备与终端UE之间建立或更新或切换波束链路,实现信道或参考信号的传输。
在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后,终端可以判断是否到达设定应 用时间,并在设定应用时间到达的情况下,完成或者实现第一指示命令所指示的信息信号的更新,也即对所指示的信息信号的更新生效。
其中,信息信号可以为波束切换过程中的波束信息,也可以为路损参考信号更新过程中的路损参考信号(Pathloss Reference Signal,PLRS),或者也可以为跟踪参考信号触发或配置或激活过程中的跟踪参考信号(Tracking Reference Signal,TRS),或者也可以为其它类型的参考信号或信息,本申请实施例并不作限制。
为叙述方便,以下可以以波束切换过程为例,对本申请实施例的技术方案进行展开说明。需要说明的是,上述波束信息,也可以称为:空间关系(spatial relation)信息、空域发送滤波器(spatial domain transmission filter)信息、空域接收滤波器(spatial domain reception filter)信息、空域滤波器(spatial filter)信息、传输配置指示状态(Transceiver Configuration Indicator state,TCI state)信息、准共址(Quasi Co-Location,QCL)信息或QCL参数等。其中,下行波束信息通常可使用TCI state信息或QCL信息表示,上行波束信息通常可使用TCI state信息或空间关系信息表示。
其中,设定应用时间是在第一指示命令后的某个具体时间点,且该具体时间点可以事先由协议约定或者由网络侧设备来配置。具体的,可以由网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态以及终端的能力信息中的至少一个确定,如仅根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定,或者仅根据终端的能力信息确定,或者结合目标天线面板的激活状态和终端的能力信息确定;也可以由协议约定为一个固定的时间点,也即预设固定常量,或为根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,或为结合二者所确定的一个最终值,例如可以确定预设固定常量和根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值中的较大者为设定应用时间。
其中,目标天线面板是多面板终端中的一个或多个天线面板,其是第一指示命令指示的目标信息信号或者该目标信息信号中的参考信号所 关联的或对应的天线面板。例如在波束切换过程中,目标天线面板是网络侧设备指示需要切换至的波束所属的天线面板。
其中,天线面板,也可以称为:天线组、天线端口组、天线集合、天线端口集合、波束集合、波束子集合、天线阵列、天线端口阵列、天线子阵列、天线端口子阵列、逻辑实体、实体或天线实体等。
本申请提供的信息信号的更新方法,在网络侧设备通过指示命令指示了信息信号的更新的情况下,根据确定的目标天线面板的激活状态,设定实现更新的应用时间,并在该应用时间,完成网络侧指示的信息信号的更新,能够使网络侧和UE的更新时间对齐,从而可以维持正确的波束链路,保证数据传输性能。
可选地,所述目标天线面板按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号,且所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至所述目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,通过所述标识信息确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述目标天线面板;
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,根据所述第一指示命令中包括的至少一个信息信号对应的天线面板的标识信息,确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可以理解为,本申请实施例根据目标天线面板的激活状态信息确定设定应用时间需要以确定出目标天线面板为前提,也即需要从终端的多个天线面板中确定出需要应用的一个或多个天线面板作为目标天线面板。
具体的,如上所述,如果第一指示命令指示了一组信息信号,且该一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号关联有天线面板的标识信息,或者该至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联有天线面板的标识信息,则以该至少一个信息信号或者至少一个信息信号中的参考信号所关联的天线面板的标识信息对应的天线面板,作为目标天线面板。
或者,如果第一指示命令指示了一组信息信号,且该一组信息信号中(或第一指示命令中)存在至少一个信息信号对应有天线面板的标识信息,则以该至少一个信息信号所对应的天线面板的标识信息对应的天线面板,作为目标天线面板。
或者,也可以先分别根据上述两种方式确定出两组备选的目标天线面板,再根据这两组备选的目标天线面板,确定出最终的目标天线面板。例如,可以确定出这两组备选的目标天线面板中均包含的天线面板,作为最终的目标天线面板。
其中,天线面板(Panel)的标识信息可以为:天线面板的标识、参考信号资源标识、参考信号资源集标识、TCI状态标识、QCL信息标识或空间关系标识等,本申请实施例并不作限制。
例如,在第一指示命令指示的波束信息为TCI状态信息时,可以根据TCI状态信息所关联的目标panel标识信息确定目标panel;或者,根据TCI状态信息中的reference signal所关联的目标panel标识信息确定目标panel;或者,在在所述第一指示命令中包括了与TCI状态信息对应的目标panel的标识信息,据此可确定出目标panel。
本申请实施例通过确定第一指示命令指示的信息信号或者信息信号中的参考信号所关联的天线面板的标识信息,或者第一指示命令所包含的天线面板的标识信息,确定出最终的目标天线面板,能够更精确的进行目标信息信号的更新。
可选地,在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,所述目标天线面板按如下方式确定:在所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板,或者,根据第一预设规则,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中的一个为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可以理解为,实际应用中可能存在第一指示命令指示的信息信号或者该信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况,则需要分情况从这多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中确定出最终的目标天线面板。
具体的,可以直接根据关联到多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所关联的多个天线面板标识信息,分别确定对应的天线面板。则根据多个天线面板标识信息对应可得到多个天线面板,于是可以将该多个天线面板均确定为该信息信号对应的目标天线面板,则对应的目标天线面板就有多个。
或者,也可以根据预设规则,从这多个天线面板标识信息中确定出一个(或者也可以是多个)目标天线面板标识信息,并将其对应的天线面板作为目标天线面板。由于天线面板标识信息与天线面板间存在对应关系,则该方案也可以理解为是从多个天线面板表示信息对应的多个天线面板中确定出一个(或者也可以是多个)作为目标天线面板。为便于区分,其中的预设规则可称为是第一预设规则。
可选地,所述第一预设规则,包括以下至少之一:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中最大者对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板;
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可以理解为,本申请实施例在从上述多个天线面板标识信息中确定出一个(或者也可以是多个)天线面板标识信息时,可以从天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值维度和/或天线面板标识信息的排 列位置维度,对各天线面板标识信息进行评估,确定出其中一个(或者也可以是多个)天线面板标识信息,并将其对应的天线面板确定为关联到上述多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所对应的目标天线面板。
具体的,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息以及各天线面板标识信息对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,则通过比较这些L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,确定出其中的最大者,也即最大的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将其对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为关联到上述多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所对应的目标天线面板。或者,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息,则可以确定出这些天线面板标识信息分别排列的位置,并基于此确定出排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息,从而可以进一步确定出该天线面板标识信息对应的天线面板,并将其确定为关联到上述多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所对应的目标天线面板。
或者,也可以先分别根据上述两种方式确定出两组备选的目标天线面板,再根据这两组备选的目标天线面板,确定出最终的目标天线面板。例如,可以确定出这两组备选的目标天线面板中均包含的天线面板,作为最终的目标天线面板。
例如,在beam report中包括的CRI中存在一个CRI,该CRI对应了多个panel标识信息和多个L1-RSRP值,其中的panel标识和L1-RSRP值是一一对应的。如果第一指示命令指示的TCI状态信息是根据该CRI确定的,那么可以将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息都作为目标panel标识信息。或者,根据第一预设规则将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息中的一个(或多个)作为目标panel标识信息,比如,将该多个panel标识信息对应的L1-RSRP值中的最大L1-RSRP值对应的panel标识信息确定为目标panel标识信息;或者,将该多个panel标识信息在波束报告中排列在最前面位置的panel标识信息作为目标panel标识信息。
可选地,以上实施例所述的关联,包括如下至少之一:
所述信息信号中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述信息信号中的参考信号的配置信息中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
在所述参考信号所属的参考信号配置/资源集/组/子集/资源中,包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号中的参考信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述信息信号中的参考信号是基于所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告确定的,且所述波束报告中包括SSBRI/CRI及与所述SSBRI/CRI对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息。
可以理解为,本申请实施例中信息信号或者信息信号中的参考信息与目标天线面板的标识信息之间的关联关系主要包括以下几种形式:直接包含(如包含在TCI状态信息中)、由所属的配置/资源集/组/子集/资源等包含(如包含在信息信号的参考信号的配置信息resource setting或resource config中、参考信号资源集resource set信息中、参考信号资源子集resource subset信息中、参考信号组resource group信息中、参考信号资源resource信息中)、网络侧设备指示了相关联以及通过波束报告相关联等,具体可以表现为如上列举的关联关系中的至少一种。
其中应说明的是,对于上述列举的最后一种关联关系,首先由终端向网络侧设备上报波束报告,该波束报告中会包括SSBRI/CRI,以及与SSBRI/CRI对应的天线面板的标识信息和这些标识信息所对应的L1- RSRP/L1-SINR。网络侧设备在接收到波束报告后,可以根据波束报告中天线面板及其对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,选择出SSBRI/CRI所对应的参考信号信息,据此指示一组信息信号,由于所指示的信息信号或信息信号中的参考信号与所基于的SSBRI/CRI相关联,并进一步由于SSBRI/CRI与天线面板的标识信息的对应关系,产生所指示的信息信号或信息信号中的参考信号与天线面板的标识信息的关联关系。
可选地,所述目标天线面板的激活状态按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的第一报告中包括所述目标天线面板的激活状态信息的情况下,根据所述第一报告,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板的标识信息包括在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的波束报告中的情况下,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,否则确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,根据第二预设规则,确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态。
可以理解为,本申请实施例可以根据如上述列举的多种目标天线面板的激活状态的确定方式中的任一种或者任意多种的组合,最终确定目标天线面板的激活状态。
具体的,可以通过UE向网络侧设备发送第一报告,上报目标天线面板的激活状态。即,UE可以上报第一报告,第一报告的特征是包括:panel的激活状态信息,例如,激活态、去激活态、仅对下行链路激活态、仅对上行链路激活态等至少之一。其中,第一报告可以不同于波束报告,或者与波束报告是同一报告。
或者,根据目标天线面板的标识信息是否包含在波束报告内的情 况,确定目标天线面板的激活状态。即,确定在波束报告中没有包括的panel标识信息对应的panel为去激活态,将波束报告包括的panel标识信息对应的panel认为是激活态。
或者,在目标天线面板为多个的情况下,根据预设规则或者由终端自确定各目标天线面板的激活状态。其中终端自确定各目标天线面板的激活状态时,终端可以自行确定多个panel标识信息对应的panel的状态,如自行确定一个panel为激活态,其余panel为去激活态;或自行确认所述多个panel标识信息对应的panel均为激活态。
或者,也可以结合上述确定方式中的任意多个,最终确定出目标天线面板的激活状态。例如,将按照各种方式均判断为激活态的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,或者按照各种方式的判断结果为激活态的个数超过设定阈值的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,本申请实施例并不作限制。
可选地,所述第二预设规则,包括:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中前M个较大值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除所述前M个较大值以外的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,M为正整数;
或者,
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将除所述P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息之外的目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,P为正整数;
或者,
将所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息对应的多个目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
可以理解为,本申请实施例在确定目标天线面板的激活状态时,可以从天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值维度和/或天线面板标识信息的排列位置维度,对各天线面板标识信息进行评估,以确定对应的目标天线面板的激活状态。
具体的,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息以及各天线面板标识信息对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,则通过比较这些L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,确定出其中较大的M个,也即前M个较大值,并将这前M个较大值分别对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态。对于这些L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除前M个较大值以外的其它L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,将该其它L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值分别对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态。
或者,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息,则可以确定出这些天线面板标识信息分别排列的位置,并基于此确定出排列在预设位置的P个天线面板标识信息,从而可以进一步确定出这P个天线面板标识信息对应的P个目标天线面板,并将这P个目标天线面板的激活状态确定为激活态,将多个目标天线面板中除这P个目标天线面板以外的目标天线面板确定为去激活态。
或者,将上述的多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
例如,在beam report中包括的CRI中存在一个CRI,该CRI对应了多个panel标识信息和多个L1-RSRP值,其中的panel标识和L1-RSRP值是一一对应的。如果第一指示命令指示的TCI状态信息是根据该CRI确定的,那么可以比较该CRI对应的多个L1-RSRP值,由大到小排列,将前M个大值对应的panel标识信息对应的panel确定为激活态,将其余 panel确定为去激活态。或者,将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息在波束报告中排列在最前面位置的P个panel标识信息对应的panel确定为激活态,将其余panel确定为去激活态。或者,将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息对应的panel都确定为激活态。
或者,也可以先分别根据上述三种方式中的任意两种或三种确定出对应的两组或三组待确认的目标天线面板激活状态,再根据这两组或三组待确认的目标天线面板激活状态,最终确定出目标天线面板的激活状态。例如,将按照各种方式均判断为激活态的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,或者按照各种方式的判断结果为激活态的个数超过设定阈值的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,本申请实施例并不作限制。
在确定目标天线面板的激活状态的基础上,UE可以根据上述规则,将认为是去激活态的panel去激活。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可以理解为,在上述各实施例的基础上,在信息信号具体为波束信息、路损参考信号PLRS或者跟踪参考信号TRS的情况下,当第一指示信息指示的一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或者该至少一个信息信号的参考信号关联的目标天线面板标识信息对应的目标天线面板为去激活态时,需要在现有协议约定的应用时间的基础上,再延迟第一预设时长,得到最终该至少一个信息信号对应的应用时间,也即设定应用时间。
也就是说,网络侧设备可以先使用第一指示命令指示一组TCI  state,其中第一指示命令指示一组TCI state,可以是MAC CE命令激活一组TCI state,或者DCI指示一组TCI state,且一组TCI state中至少包括一个TCI state。
如果,所述一组TCI state中,存在至少一个TCI state,该TCI state或该TCI state中的参考信号关联了未激活的天线面板,则协议约定或网络侧设备配置所述至少一个TCI state的波束应用时间(beam application time,BAT)为第一预设时间+第一预设时长。
其中,第一预设时间可以是现有协议中的应用时间,如现有协议的波束应用时间,其通常是协议约定的固定值或者由网络侧设备配置。第一预设时长则是和目标天线面板的激活状态相关的附加时延,可以是由网络侧设备根据终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
举例说明,上面所述的至少一个信息信号对应的应用时间,也即是设定应用时间,可以为如下任一:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长。
其中,第一预设时间可以为第一指示命令后或者第一指示命令的ACK传输时间之后的X ms、Y symbol或Z slot,第一预设时长,可以是基于UE上报的UE能力(capability)确定,该时长满足panel激活所需的时长。
例如,如果第一指示命令是MAC CE,则波束信息对应的设定应用时间,即波束应用时间BAT可以为MAC CE的ACK时间+3ms+目标panel激活时延。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:第一预设时间;其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,在上述实施例的场景下,若区别仅在于目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,则根据上述实施例计算的设定应用时间中,不再包括与目标天线面板的激活过程相关的第一预设时长。也就是说,如果所述一组TCI state关联了激活的panel,或者所述一组TCI state中的参考信号都关联了激活的panel,则上述目标天线面板为去激活态时设定应用时间包括的第一预设时长不再需要。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,与上述目标天线面板为去激活态时设定应用时间中第一预设时间类似,目标天线面板激活态下对应的设定应用时间也可以是现有协议中的应用时间,如现有协议的波束应用时间,其通常是协议约定的固定值或者由网络侧设备配置。
其中,当根据第二预设规则,确定出目标天线面板是激活态或去激活态的情况下,在第一指示命令指示的一组TCI state中,存在TCI state的参考信号是根据去激活态panel的标识信息对应的SSBRI/CRI所确定时,上述实施例中该TCI state对应的设定应用时间中的第一预设时长需 要;在所述一组TCI state中,存在TCI state的参考信号是根据激活态panel的标识信息对应的SSBRI/CRI所确定时,上述实施例中该TCI state对应的设定应用时间中的第一预设时长不再需要。
可选地,在所述通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态的情况下,所述设定应用时间由协议约定或者由所述网络侧设备配置固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可以理解为,当波束报告中包括的SSBRI/CRI中,有SSBRI/CRI对应多个panel标识信息时,则若第一指示命令指示的一组TCI state中,存在TCI state中的参考信号是根据对应多个panel标识信息的该SSBRI/CRI所确定时,可以由UE自行确定多个panel标识信息对应的panel的激活状态。
这种情况下,网络侧设备无法获知panel的激活状态,则可以总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
或者,总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间(无第一预设时长):
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间。
其中的第一预设时间及第一预设时长可与上述各实施例相同,此处不再赘述。
可选地,所述设定应用时间固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设 备配置,所述第一预设时长由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值或者为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长。
可以理解为,本申请实施例在确定设定应用时间时,可以不考虑目标天线面板的激活状态,总是将设定应用时间设置为具体的时间。如:
总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
或者,
总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间(无第一预设时长):
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间。
其中的第一预设时间及第一预设时长可与上述各实施例相同,此处不再赘述。其中,在PLRS的场景中,PLRS对应的应用时间中的第一预设时间可以是现有协议约定的应用时间+N个样点。
另外,在设定应用时间之后,UE可以跟踪/测量一组TCI state,或者跟踪/测量一组TCI state中每个TCI state中的参考信号。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间,所述第一应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,对于路损参考信号(pathloss RS,PLRS)的应用时间,当网络侧设备使用第一指示命令(或者也可以称为第二指示命令,与上述实施例的第一指示命令相同或不同)指示更新PLRS时,可以根据PLRS所关联的panel的状态,确定其应用时间,为与上述实施例的通用设定应用时间相区分,该应用时间可称为是第一应用时间。
如果更新的PLRS关联的panel为去激活态,则待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间可以使用现有协议中的应用时间+第三预设时长,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms(+N个样点)+第三预设时长。
其中,现有协议中的应用时间即可作为第二预设时间。并且,第二预设时间可以与上述各实施例中的第一预设时间相同,或者也可以为第一预设时间+N个样点。其中第三预设时长可以与上述各实施例中的第一预设时长相同。
其中,第二预设时间可以是协议约定的固定值或者由网络侧设备配置,第三预设时长为由网络侧设备根据终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第二应用时间,所述第二应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,在上述实施例的情形下,若区别仅在于天线面板的状态为激活态,则上述实施例中的第三预设时长不再需要。即,如果更新 的PLRS关联的panel为激活态,则使用现有协议中的应用时间作为对应PLRS的第一应用时间,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms,或ACK时间+3ms+N sample。
可选地,对于上述目标天线面板为激活态或者为去激活态的情形,所述第二预设时间均可以为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,对于上述PLRS的实施例,包括目标天线面板为激活态的实施例和目标天线面板为去激活态的实施例,其中与目标天线面板的状态无关的第二预设时间可以是上述列出的任一个。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第三应用时间,所述第三应用时间固定为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,与上述通用信息信号的设定应用时间类似,也可以直 接由协议约定或者由网络侧设备配置PLRS对应的应用时间,而无需考虑目标天线面板的激活状态。具体的,可以总是将PLRS的应用时间确认为现有协议中的应用时间+第三预设时长,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms(+N个样点)+第三预设时长,或者,总是将PLRS的应用时间确认为现有协议中的应用时间,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms(+N个样点)。
另外,如上述实施例所述,PLRS的应用时间也可以总是与上述波束信息的应用时间BAT相同,或者总是为上述BAT+N个样点。其中,N取决于UE capability,或者N为固定值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,与上述PLRS的实施例中目标天线面板为激活态的实施例和目标天线面板为去激活态的实施例类似,可以通过协议约定或网络侧设备配置设定应用时间中与目标天线面板的状态无关的第二预设时间可以是上述列出的任一个。
可选地,所述信息信号的更新方法还包括:所述终端接收所述网络侧设备下发的第二指示命令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号;则,在所述一组路损参考信号中存在至少一个路损参考信号为所述第一指示命令指示的一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号的情况下,所述至少一个路损参考信号对应的应用时间为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间,或者,为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间+N个样点;其中,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的 预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,对于PLRS的应用,如果网络侧设备事先指示了一组TCI状态,且又通过第二指示命令指示了一组PLRS,则可以判断该PLRS是否为网络侧设备事先指示的一组TCI状态中的参考信号,如果存在至少一个PLRS为该一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号,则将该至少一个PLRS对应的应用时间确定为该任一个TCI状态所对应的设定应用时间,或者,为该任一个TCI状态对应的设定应用时间+N个样点。即如果一组PLRS中的任一个PLRS是一组TCI state中的TCI state中的参考信号,则该PLRS对应的应用时间与上述各实施例的BAT相同或BAT+N样点。
可选地,若所述一组路损参考信号中存在任一路损参考信号不为所述一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态所包含的参考信号,则所述任一路损参考信号对应的应用时间为如下之一:
第三预设时间;
第三预设时间+N个样点;
第三预设时间+第三预设时长;
第三预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
所述设定应用时间;
所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
其中,所述第三预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,对于PLRS的应用,如果网络侧设备事先指示了一组TCI状态,且又通过第二指示命令指示了一组PLRS,则可以判断该PLRS是否为网络侧设备事先指示的一组TCI状态中的参考信号,如果存 在任一PLRS不为该一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态中的参考信号,则将该任一PLRS对应的应用时间确定为:现有协议中的应用时间,或者,现有协议中的应用时间+第三预设时长,或者,上述各实施例中的BAT,或者,上述各实施例中的BAT+N sample,或者,上述各实施例中的BAT+N sample+第三预设时长,或者,与上述各实施例类似,根据PLRS所关联的panel的状态,确定其应用时间,具体包括上述列举的应用时间中的任一个。
可选地,所述第三预设时间可以为如下之一:
所述第二指示命令的传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,与上述实施例类似,对于PLRS,可以由协议约定或网络侧设备配置的与panel激活状态无关的第三预设时间为上述列举的应用时间中的任一个。
可选地,在所述信息信号为跟踪参考信号TRS,且所述第一指示命令指示的TRS为周期或半持续TRS的情况下,所述周期或半持续TRS对应的所述第一预设时间为:所述网络侧设备配置的所述周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。
可以理解为,对于上述实施例中的信息信号具体是跟踪参考信号TRS的情况,如果TRS是周期或半持续TRS,则根据上述实施例中的第一预设时间为现有协议中周期或半持续TRS的传输时间,具体可以是网络侧设备配置的周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。其中,传输时间是根据网络侧设备配置的该周期或半持续TRS传输的周期值和偏移值确定的。则在跟踪参考信号TRS对应的第一指示命令后,在TRS的传输时间基础 上,若为未激活panel,则还需加第一预设时长,若为激活panel,则不需要加第一预设时长。
例如,如果TRS是周期TRS,网络侧设备使用RRC信令配置了该周期TRS的传输时间信息(周期值和时间偏移值),如周期值为5ms,时间偏移为1ms,则TRS的传输时间为第1ms、6ms、11ms......。若对应的目标天线面板为去激活态,且天线面板激活时延为8ms,则TRS的实际传输时间需要将原传输时间推迟天线面板的激活时延这一时长,即该周期TRS的设定应用时间为1ms+8ms、6ms+8ms、11ms+8ms......,也即9ms、14ms、19ms......。其中,第一预设时间为1ms、6ms、11ms......,第一预设时长为8ms。如果TRS对应的目标天线面板是激活态,即TRS是由终端使用激活态的目标天线面板进行测量的,则上述设定应用时间中的第一预设时长不再需要,也即该周期TRS的设定应用时间为1ms、6ms、11ms......。
在所述信息信号为非周期TRS时,网络侧设备使用第一指示命令触发非周期TRS,具体的设定应用时间与波束切换和PLRS更新的方法相同。
整体而言,当网络侧设备使用第一指示命令触发或配置或激活了TRS时,可以根据TRS关联的panel状态,确定TRS的应用时间(如传输时间或UE测量TRS的时间)为如下之一:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间,若TRS对应的目标天线面板为未激活panel,则还需加第一预设时长,若为激活panel,则不需要加;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间,若TRS对应的目标天线面板为未激活panel,则还需加第一预设时长,若为激活panel,则不需要加。
或者,总是使用TRS的传输时间,或TRS的传输时间+第一预设时长。
或者,若TRS对应多个panel标识信息,则:可根据对应不同panel 标识信息的TRS的测量结果(如测量值的大小等),确定panel状态,或可由UE自行确定panel状态;再根据panel状态,确定TRS的传输时间或UE测量TRS的时间。
应理解的是,其中得到第一预设时间、第一预设时长的含义及确定方式可与上述各实施例相同,此处不再赘述。
可选地,在所述网络侧设备下发所述第一指示命令之前,所述信息信号的更新方法还包括:所述终端根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备发送波束报告。
具体而言,以波束切换为例,本申请实施例可以理解为,在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令以指示具体待更新的信息信号之前,终端可以先进行波束信息测量,并根据测量结果,生成对应的波束报告上报给网络侧设备。可选地,网络侧设备可以根据终端上报的波束报告,下发第一指示命令,指示一组待更新的波束信息。
可以理解,在做波束测量时,网络侧设备可以在参考信号资源配置(RS resource config,或RS resource setting)中配置参考信号资源集合(RS resource set),其中包括至少一个参考信号资源,例如SSB resource或CSI-RS resource。UE测量每个RS resource的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,并将最优的至少一个测量结果上报给网络,上报内容例如可以包括SSBRI或CRI及其对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR。此外,还可以上报对应每个SSRBI/CRI的各个L1-RSRP/L1-SINR测量结果所使用的panel标识信息。
可选地,所述终端在信息测量的过程中,将当前为去激活态的天线面板激活后,进行信息测量,并在信息测量结束之后或者发送所述波束报告之后,将所述激活的天线面板再去激活。
具体而言,以波束切换为例,UE在进行波束测量时,将当前为去激活态的天线面板激活,以进行波束测量,并在波束测量之后或者发送波束报告之后,将原来为去激活态的天线面板再次去激活,能够有效节约 能源,提高整体效益。
终端经过测量后反馈波束报告,供网络侧设备在下一次传输业务时根据该波束报告中的相应信号确定波束指示信息中的参考信号,来实现模拟波束发射。波束报告的内容通常包括最优的若干个发射波束标识以及测量出的每个发射波束的接收功率。也即,该报告内容反映了至少一个最优的波束及其质量,供网络确定用来与UE传输信道或信号的波束信息。
可选地,所述波束报告中包括如下信息中至少之一:
SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR;
天线面板标识信息,所述天线面板标识信息与SSBRI/CRI相对应。
具体而言,在终端向网络侧设备上报的上述波束报告中,可以选择性包含上述内容中的任一项或者任意多项的组合。如仅包括SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,或仅包括天线面板标识信息,或同时包括SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,以及天线面板标识信息。
其中,天线面板标识信息可以与SSBRI/CRI相对应,即在波束报告中每个SSBRI/CRI都有一个或多个相应的天线面板标识信息,不同的SSBRI/CRI对应的天线面板标识信息可以相同或者不同。
需要说明的是,本申请实施例提供的终端侧的信息信号的更新方法,执行主体可以为信息信号的更新装置,或者,该信息信号的更新装置中的用于执行加载终端侧信息信号的更新方法的控制模块。本申请实施例中以信息信号的更新装置执行终端侧信息信号的更新方法为例,说明本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置。
本申请实施例的信息信号的更新装置的结构如图3所示,为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置的结构示意图之一,该装置可以用于实现上述终端侧各信息信号的更新方法实施例中信息信号的更新,该装置包括:
第一处理模块301,用于在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新。
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可选地,所述目标天线面板按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号,且所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至所述目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,通过所述标识信息确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述目标天线面板;
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,则根据所述第一指示命令中包括的至少一个信息信号对应的天线面板的标识信息,确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可选地,在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,所述目标天线面板按如下方式确定:
在所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板,或者,根据第一预设规则,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中的一个为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可选地,所述第一预设规则,包括以下至少之一:
在终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中最大者对应的天线 面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板;
在终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可选地,所述目标天线面板的激活状态按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在终端向所述网络侧设备发送的第一报告中包括所述目标天线面板的激活状态信息的情况下,根据所述第一报告,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板的标识信息包括在终端向所述网络侧设备发送的波束报告中的情况下,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,否则确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,根据第二预设规则,确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,通过终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态。
可选地,所述第二预设规则,包括:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中前M个较大值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除所述前M个较大值以外的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,M为正整数;
或者,
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标 天线面板的标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将除所述P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息之外的目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,P为正整数;
或者,
将所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息对应的多个目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
第一预设时间;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态的情况下,所述设定应用时间由协议约定或者由所述网络侧设备配置固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可选地,所述设定应用时间固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值或者为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间,所述第一应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所 述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第二应用时间,所述第二应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第三应用时间,所述第三应用时间固定为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,所述信息信号的更新装置还包括:
接收模块,用于接收所述网络侧设备下发的第二指示命令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号;
则,在所述一组路损参考信号中存在至少一个路损参考信号为所述第一指示命令指示的一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号的情况下,所述至少一个路损参考信号对应的应用时间为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间,或者,为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
其中,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,若所述一组路损参考信号中存在任一路损参考信号不为所 述一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态所包含的参考信号,则所述任一路损参考信号对应的应用时间为如下之一:
第三预设时间;
第三预设时间+N个样点;
第三预设时间+第三预设时长;
第三预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
所述设定应用时间;
所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
其中,所述第三预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第三预设时间为如下之一:
所述第二指示命令的传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述信息信号为跟踪参考信号TRS,且所述第一指示命令指示的TRS为周期或半持续TRS的情况下,所述周期或半持续TRS对应的所述第一预设时间为:
所述网络侧设备配置的所述周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。
可选地,所述关联,包括如下至少之一:
所述信息信号中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述信息信号中的参考信号的配置信息中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
在所述参考信号所属的参考信号配置/资源集/组/子集/资源中,包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号中的参考信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述信息信号中的参考信号是基于所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告确定的,且所述波束报告中包括SSBRI/CRI及与所述SSBRI/CRI对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息。
可选地,所述信息信号的更新装置,还包括第一发送模块,用于:在所述网络侧设备下发所述第一指示命令之前,根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备发送波束报告。
可选地,所述波束报告中包括如下信息中至少之一:
SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR;
天线面板标识信息,所述天线面板标识信息与SSBRI/CRI相对应。
可选地,所述信息信号的更新装置,还包括第一测量模块,用于:在信息测量的过程中,将当前为去激活态的天线面板激活后,进行信息测量,并在信息测量结束之后或者发送所述波束报告之后,将所述激活的天线面板再去激活。
本申请实施例中的信息信号的更新装置可以是装置,具有操作系统的装置或电子设备,也可以是终端设备中的部件、集成电路、或芯片。该装置或电子设备可以是可移动终端,也可以为非移动终端。示例性的,可移动终端可以包括但不限于上述所列举的终端101的类型,非移 动终端可以为服务器、网络附属存储器(Network Attached Storage,NAS)、个人计算机(personal computer,PC)、电视机(television,TV)、柜员机或者自助机等,本申请实施例不作具体限定。
本申请实施例中的信息信号的更新装置可以为具有操作系统的装置。该操作系统可以为安卓(Android)操作系统,可以为IOS操作系统,还可以为其他可能的操作系统,本申请实施例不作具体限定。
本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置能够实现图2的方法实施例实现的各个过程,并达到相同的技术效果,为避免重复,这里不再赘述。
本申请实施例还提供一种信息信号的更新方法,该方法可由网络侧设备执行,该网络侧设备具体可以是图1中示出的网络侧设备102。如图4所示,为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新方法的流程示意图之二,该方法包括:
步骤401,网络侧设备下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新。
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
具体而言,在需要对网络连接中的信息信号进行更新时,网络侧设备可以向终端下发指示命令,以指示需要进行更新以及更新所涉及的具体信息信号。为便于区分,其中的指示命令可称为是第一指示命令,且可以通过该第一指示命令,指示具体的需更新的信息信号。
例如,在波束切换的场景中,在经过UE的波束测量和波束报告后,网络侧设备可以对下行与上行链路的信道或参考信号做波束指示,也即下发第一指示命令,用于在网络侧设备与终端UE之间建立或更新或切换 波束链路,实现信道或参考信号的传输。
在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后,网络侧设备可以判断是否到达设定应用时间,并在设定应用时间到达的情况下,完成或者实现第一指示命令所指示的信息信号的更新,也即对所指示的信息信号的更新生效。
其中,信息信号可以为波束切换过程中的波束信息,也可以为路损参考信号更新过程中的路损参考信号(Pathloss Reference Signal,PLRS),或者也可以为跟踪参考信号触发或配置或激活过程中的跟踪参考信号(Tracking Reference Signal,TRS),或者也可以为其它类型的参考信号或信息,本申请实施例并不作限制。
为叙述方便,以下可以以波束切换过程为例,对本申请实施例的技术方案进行展开说明。需要说明的是,上述波束信息,也可以称为:空间关系(spatialrelation)信息、空域发送滤波器(spatial domain transmission filter)信息、空域接收滤波器(spatial domain reception filter)信息、空域滤波器(spatial filter)信息、传输配置指示状态(Transceiver Configuration Indicator state,TCI state)信息、准共址(Quasi Co-Location,QCL)信息或QCL参数等。其中,下行波束信息通常可使用TCI state信息或QCL信息表示,上行波束信息通常可使用TCI state信息或空间关系信息表示。
其中,设定应用时间是在第一指示命令后的某个具体时间点,且该具体时间点可以事先由协议约定或者由网络侧设备来配置。具体的,可以由网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态以及终端的能力信息中的至少一个确定,如仅根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定,或者仅根据终端的能力信息确定,或者结合目标天线面板的激活状态和终端的能力信息确定;也可以由协议约定为一个固定的时间点,也即预设固定常量,或为根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,或为结合二者所确定的一个最终值,例如可以确定预设固定常量和根据目标天线面板的激活状态 确定的值中的较大者为设定应用时间。
其中,目标天线面板是多面板终端中的一个或多个天线面板,其是第一指示命令指示的目标信息信号或者该目标信息信号中的参考信号所关联的或对应的天线面板。例如在波束切换过程中,目标天线面板是网络侧设备指示需要切换至的波束所属的天线面板。
其中,天线面板,也可以称为:天线组、天线端口组、天线集合、天线端口集合、波束集合、波束子集合、天线阵列、天线端口阵列、天线子阵列、天线端口子阵列、逻辑实体、实体或天线实体等。
本申请提供的信息信号的更新方法,在网络侧设备通过指示命令指示了信息信号的更新的情况下,根据确定的目标天线面板的激活状态,设定实现更新的应用时间,并在该应用时间,完成网络侧指示的信息信号的更新,能够使网络侧和UE的更新时间对齐,从而可以维持正确的波束链路,保证数据传输性能。
可选地,所述目标天线面板按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号,且所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或所述至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至所述目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,通过所述标识信息确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述目标天线面板;
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,根据所述第一指示命令中包括的至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板的标识信息,确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可以理解为,本申请实施例根据目标天线面板的激活状态信息确定设定应用时间需要以确定出目标天线面板为前提,也即需要从终端的多个天线面板中确定出需要应用的一个或多个天线面板作为目标天线面板。
具体的,如上所述,如果第一指示命令指示了一组信息信号,且该一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号关联有天线面板的标识信息,或 者该至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联有天线面板的标识信息,则以该至少一个信息信号或者至少一个信息信号中的参考信号所关联的天线面板的标识信息对应的天线面板,作为目标天线面板。
或者,如果第一指示命令指示了一组信息信号,且该一组信息信号中(或第一指示命令中)存在至少一个信息信号对应有天线面板的标识信息,则以该至少一个信息信号所对应的天线面板的标识信息对应的天线面板,作为目标天线面板。
或者,也可以先分别根据上述两种方式确定出两组备选的目标天线面板,再根据这两组备选的目标天线面板,确定出最终的目标天线面板。例如,可以确定出这两组备选的目标天线面板中均包含的天线面板,作为最终的目标天线面板。
其中,天线面板(Panel)的标识信息可以为:天线面板的标识、参考信号资源标识、参考信号资源集标识、TCI状态标识、QCL信息标识或空间关系标识等,本申请实施例并不作限制。
例如,在第一指示命令指示的波束信息为TCI状态信息时,可以根据TCI状态信息所关联的目标panel标识信息确定目标panel;或者,根据TCI状态信息中的reference signal所关联的目标panel标识信息确定目标panel;或者,在在所述第一指示命令中包括了与TCI状态信息对应的目标panel的标识信息,据此可确定出目标panel。
本申请实施例通过确定第一指示命令指示的信息信号或者信息信号中的参考信号所关联的天线面板的标识信息,或者第一指示命令所包含的天线面板的标识信息,确定出最终的目标天线面板,能够更精确的进行目标信息信号的更新。
可选地,在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,所述目标天线面板按如下方式确定:在所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板为所述至 少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板,或者,根据第一预设规则,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中的一个为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可以理解为,实际应用中可能存在第一指示命令指示的信息信号或者该信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况,则需要分情况从这多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中确定出最终的目标天线面板。
具体的,可以直接根据关联到多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所关联的多个天线面板标识信息,分别确定对应的天线面板。则根据多个天线面板标识信息对应可得到多个天线面板,于是可以将该多个天线面板均确定为该信息信号对应的目标天线面板,则对应的目标天线面板就有多个。
或者,也可以根据预设规则,从这多个天线面板标识信息中确定出一个(或者也可以是多个)目标天线面板标识信息,并将其对应的天线面板作为目标天线面板。由于天线面板标识信息与天线面板间存在对应关系,则该方案也可以理解为是从多个天线面板表示信息对应的多个天线面板中确定出一个(或者也可以是多个)作为目标天线面板。为便于区分,其中的预设规则可称为是第一预设规则。
可选地,所述第一预设规则,包括以下至少之一:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中最大者对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板;
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可以理解为,本申请实施例在从上述多个天线面板标识信息中确定出一个(或者也可以是多个)天线面板标识信息时,可以从天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值维度和/或天线面板标识信息的排列位置维度,对各天线面板标识信息进行评估,确定出其中一个(或者也可以是多个)天线面板标识信息,并将其对应的天线面板确定为关联到上述多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所对应的目标天线面板。
具体的,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息以及各天线面板标识信息对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,则通过比较这些L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,确定出其中的最大者,也即最大的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将其对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为关联到上述多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所对应的目标天线面板。
或者,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息,则可以确定出这些天线面板标识信息分别排列的位置,并基于此确定出排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息,从而可以进一步确定出该天线面板标识信息对应的天线面板,并将其确定为关联到上述多个天线面板标识信息的信息信号所对应的目标天线面板。
或者,也可以先分别根据上述两种方式确定出两组备选的目标天线面板,再根据这两组备选的目标天线面板,确定出最终的目标天线面板。例如,可以确定出这两组备选的目标天线面板中均包含的天线面板,作为最终的目标天线面板。
例如,在beam report中包括的CRI中存在一个CRI,该CRI对应了多个panel标识信息和多个L1-RSRP值,其中的panel标识和L1-RSRP值是一一对应的。如果第一指示命令指示的TCI状态信息是根据该CRI确定的,那么可以将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息都作为目标panel标识信息。或者,根据第一预设规则将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息中确定一个(或多个)作为目标panel标识信息,比如,将该多个panel 标识信息对应的L1-RSRP值中的最大L1-RSRP值对应的panel标识信息确定为目标panel标识信息;或者,将该多个panel标识信息在波束报告中排列在最前面位置的panel标识信息作为目标panel标识信息。
可选地,以上实施例所述的关联,包括如下至少之一:
所述信息信号中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述信息信号中的参考信号的配置信息中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
在所述参考信号所属的参考信号配置/资源集/组/子集/资源中,包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号中的参考信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述信息信号中的参考信号是基于所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告确定的,且所述波束报告中包括SSBRI/CRI及与所述SSBRI/CRI对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息。
可以理解为,本申请实施例中信息信号或者信息信号中的参考信息与目标天线面板的标识信息之间的关联关系主要包括以下几种形式:直接包含(如包含在TCI状态信息中)、由所属的配置/资源集/组/子集/资源等包含(如包含在信息信号的参考信号的配置信息resource setting或resource config中、参考信号资源集resource set信息中、参考信号资源子集resource subset信息中、参考信号组resource group信息中、参考信号资源resource信息中)、网络侧设备指示了相关联以及通过波束报告相关联等,具体可以表现为如上列举的关联关系中的至少一种。
其中应说明的是,对于上述列举的最后一种关联关系,首先由终端向网络侧设备上报波束报告,该波束报告中会包括SSBRI/CRI,以及与SSBRI/CRI对应的天线面板的标识信息和这些标识信息所对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR。网络侧设备在接收到波束报告后,可以根据波束报告中天线面板及其对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,选择出SSBRI/CRI所对应的参考信号信息,据此指示一组信息信号,由于所指示的信息信号或信息信号中的参考信号与所基于的SSBRI/CRI相关联,并进一步由于SSBRI/CRI与天线面板的标识信息的对应关系,产生所指示的信息信号或信息信号中的参考信号与天线面板的标识信息的关联关系。
可选地,所述目标天线面板的激活状态按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的第一报告中包括所述目标天线面板的激活状态信息的情况下,根据所述第一报告,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板的标识信息包括在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的波束报告中的情况下,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,否则确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,根据第二预设规则,确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态。
可以理解为,本申请实施例可以根据如上述列举的多种目标天线面板的激活状态的确定方式中的任一种或者任意多种的组合,最终确定目标天线面板的激活状态。
具体的,可以通过UE向网络侧设备发送第一报告,上报目标天线面板的激活状态。即,UE可以上报第一报告,第一报告的特征是包括:panel的激活状态信息,例如,激活态、去激活态、仅对下行链路激活 态、仅对上行链路激活态等至少之一。其中,第一报告可以不同于波束报告,或者与波束报告是同一报告。
或者,根据目标天线面板的标识信息是否包含在波束报告内的情况,确定目标天线面板的激活状态。即,确定在波束报告中没有包括的panel标识信息对应的panel为去激活态,将波束报告包括的panel标识信息对应的panel认为是激活态。
或者,在目标天线面板为多个的情况下,根据预设规则或者由终端自确定各目标天线面板的激活状态。其中终端自确定各目标天线面板的激活状态时,终端可以自行确定多个panel标识信息对应的panel的状态,如自行确定一个panel为激活态,其余panel为去激活态;或自行确认所述多个panel标识信息对应的panel均为激活态。
或者,也可以结合上述确定方式中的任意多个,最终确定出目标天线面板的激活状态。例如,将按照各种方式均判断为激活态的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,或者按照各种方式的判断结果为激活态的个数超过设定阈值的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,本申请实施例并不作限制。
可选地,所述第二预设规则,包括:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中前M个较大值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除所述前M个较大值以外的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,M为正整数;
或者,
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的P个所述目标天线 面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将除所述P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息之外的目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,P为正整数;
或者,
将所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息对应的多个目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
可以理解为,本申请实施例在确定目标天线面板的激活状态时,可以从天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值维度和/或天线面板标识信息的排列位置维度,对各天线面板标识信息进行评估,以确定对应的目标天线面板的激活状态。
具体的,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息以及各天线面板标识信息对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,则通过比较这些L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,确定出其中较大的M个,也即前M个较大值,并将这前M个较大值分别对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态。对于这些L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除前M个较大值以外的其它L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,将该其它L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值分别对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态。
或者,如果终端向网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括了上述的多个天线面板标识信息,则可以确定出这些天线面板标识信息分别排列的位置,并基于此确定出排列在预设位置的P个天线面板标识信息,从而可以进一步确定出这P个天线面板标识信息对应的P个目标天线面板,并将这P个目标天线面板的激活状态确定为激活态,将多个目标天线面板中除这P个目标天线面板以外的目标天线面板确定为去激活态。
或者,将上述的多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
例如,在beam report中包括的CRI中存在一个CRI,该CRI对应了多个panel标识信息和多个L1-RSRP值,其中的panel标识和L1-RSRP 值是一一对应的。如果第一指示命令指示的TCI状态信息是根据该CRI确定的,那么可以比较该CRI对应的多个L1-RSRP值,由大到小排列,将前M个大值对应的panel标识信息对应的panel确定为激活态,将其余panel确定为去激活态。或者,将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息在波束报告中排列在最前面位置的P个panel标识信息对应的panel确定为激活态,将其余panel确定为去激活态。或者,将该CRI对应的多个panel标识信息对应的panel都确定为激活态。
或者,也可以先分别根据上述三种方式中的任意两种或三种确定出对应的两组或三组待确认的目标天线面板激活状态,再根据这两组或三组待确认的目标天线面板激活状态,最终确定出目标天线面板的激活状态。例如,将按照各种方式均判断为激活态的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,或者按照各种方式的判断结果为激活态的个数超过设定阈值的目标天线面板的状态确认为激活态,本申请实施例并不作限制。
在确定目标天线面板的激活状态的基础上,UE可以根据上述规则,将认为是去激活态的panel去激活。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可以理解为,在上述各实施例的基础上,在信息信号具体为波束信息、路损参考信号PLRS或者跟踪参考信号TRS的情况下,当第一指示信息指示的一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或者该至少一个信息信号的参考信号关联的目标天线面板标识信息对应的目标天线面板为去激活态时,需要在现有协议约定的应用时间的基础上,再延迟第一预设 时长,得到最终该至少一个信息信号对应的应用时间,也即设定应用时间。
也就是说,网络侧设备可以先使用第一指示命令指示一组TCI state,其中第一指示命令指示一组TCI state,可以是MAC CE命令激活一组TCI state,或者DCI指示一组TCI state,且一组TCI state中至少包括一个TCI state。
如果,所述一组TCI state中,存在至少一个TCI state,该TCI state或该TCI state中的参考信号关联了未激活的天线面板,则协议约定或网络侧设备配置所述至少一个TCI state的波束应用时间(beam application time,BAT)为第一预设时间+第一预设时长。
其中,第一预设时间可以是现有协议中的应用时间,如现有协议的波束应用时间,其通常是协议约定的固定值或者由网络侧设备配置。第一预设时长则是和目标天线面板的激活状态相关的附加时延,可以是由网络侧设备根据终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
举例说明,上面所述的至少一个信息信号对应的应用时间,也即是设定应用时间,可以为如下任一:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长。
其中,第一预设时间可以为第一指示命令后或者第一指示命令的ACK传输时间之后的X ms、Y symbol或Z slot,第一预设时长,可以是基于UE上报的UE能力(capability)确定,该时长满足panel激活所需的时长。
例如,如果第一指示命令是MAC CE,则波束信息对应的设定应用时间,即波束应用时间BAT为MAC CE的ACK时间+3ms+目标天线面板激活时延。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:第一预设时间;其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,在上述实施例的场景下,若区别仅在于目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,则根据上述实施例计算的设定应用时间中,不再包括与目标天线面板的激活过程相关的第一预设时长。也就是说,如果所述一组TCI state关联了激活的panel,或者,所述一组TCI state中的参考信号都关联了激活的panel,则上述目标天线面板为去激活态时设定应用时间包括的第一预设时长不再需要。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,与上述目标天线面板为去激活态时设定应用时间中第一预设时间类似,目标天线面板激活态下对应的设定应用时间也可以是现有协议中的应用时间,如现有协议的波束应用时间,其通常是协议约定的固定值或者由网络侧设备配置。
其中,当根据第二预设规则,确定出目标天线面板是激活态或去激 活态的情况下,在第一指示命令指示的一组TCI state中,存在TCI state的参考信号是根据去激活态panel的标识信息对应的SSBRI/CRI所确定时,上述实施例中该TCI state对应的应用时间中的第一预设时长需要;在所述一组TCI state中,存在TCI state的参考信号是根据激活态panel的标识信息对应的SSBRI/CRI所确定时,上述实施例中该TCI state对应的应用时间中的第一预设时长不再需要。
可选地,在所述通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态的情况下,所述设定应用时间由协议约定或者由所述网络侧设备配置始终为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可以理解为,当波束报告中包括的SSBRI/CRI中,有SSBRI/CRI对应多个panel标识信息时,则若第一指示命令指示的一组TCI state中,存在TCI state中的参考信号是根据对应多个panel标识信息的该SSBRI/CRI所确定时,可以由UE自行确定多个panel标识信息对应的panel的激活状态。
这种情况下,网络侧设备无法获知panel的激活状态,则可以总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
或者,总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间(无第一预设时长):
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间。
其中的第一预设时间及第一预设时长可与上述各实施例相同,此处不再赘述。
可选地,所述设定应用时间由协议约定固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值,所述第一预设时长由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可以理解为,本申请实施例在确定设定应用时间时,可以不考虑目标天线面板的激活状态,总是将设定应用时间设置为具体的时间。如:
总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
或者,
总是使用如下之一作为设定应用时间(无第一预设时长):
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间。
其中的第一预设时间及第一预设时长可与上述各实施例相同,此处不再赘述。其中,在PLRS的场景中,PLRS对应的应用时间中的第一预设时间可以是现有协议约定的应用时间+N个样点。
另外,在设定应用时间之后,UE可以跟踪/测量一组TCI state,或者跟踪/测量一组TCI state中每个TCI state中的参考信号。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间,所述第一应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备 配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,对于路损参考信号(pathloss RS,PLRS)的应用时间,当网络侧设备使用第一指示命令(或者也可以称为第二指示命令,与上述实施例的第一指示命令相同或不同)指示更新PLRS时,可以根据PLRS所关联的panel的状态,确定其应用时间,为与上述实施例的通用设定应用时间相区分,该应用时间可称为是第一应用时间。
如果更新的PLRS关联的panel为去激活态,则待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间可以使用现有协议中的应用时间+第三预设时长,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms(+N个样点)+第三预设时长。
其中,现有协议中的应用时间即可作为第二预设时间。并且,第二预设时间可以与上述各实施例中的第一预设时间相同,或者也可以为第一预设时间+N个样点。其中第三预设时长可以与上述各实施例中的第一预设时长相同。
其中,第二预设时间可以是协议约定的固定值或者由网络侧设备配置,第三预设时长为由网络侧设备根据终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第二应用时间,所述第二应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,在上述实施例的情形下,若区别仅在于天线面板的状 态为激活态,则上述实施例中的第三预设时长不再需要。即,如果更新的PLRS关联的panel为激活态,则使用现有协议中的应用时间作为对应PLRS的第一应用时间,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms,或ACK时间+3ms+N sample。
可选地,对于上述目标天线面板为激活态或者为去激活态的情形,所述第二预设时间均可以为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,对于上述PLRS的实施例,包括目标天线面板为激活态的实施例和目标天线面板为去激活态的实施例,其中与目标天线面板的状态无关的第二预设时间可以是上述列出的任一个。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第三应用时间,所述第三应用时间固定为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,与上述通用信息信号的设定应用时间类似,也可以直接由协议约定或者由网络侧设备配置PLRS对应的应用时间,而无需考虑目标天线面板的激活状态。具体的,可以总是将PLRS的应用时间确认为现有协议中的应用时间+第三预设时长,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms(+N个样点)+第三预设时长,或者,总是将PLRS的应用时间确认为现有协议中的应用时间,如MAC CE命令的ACK时间+3ms(+N个样点)。
另外,如上述实施例所述,PLRS的应用时间也可以总是与上述波束信息的应用时间BAT相同,或者总是为上述BAT+N个样点。其中,N取决于UE capability,或者N为固定值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,与上述PLRS的实施例中目标天线面板为激活态的实施例和目标天线面板为去激活态的实施例类似,可以通过协议约定或网络侧设备配置设定应用时间中与目标天线面板的状态无关的第二预设时间可以是上述列出的任一个。
可选地,本申请实施例所述的信息信号的更新方法,还包括:所述网络侧设备向所述终端下发第二指示命令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号;则,在所述一组路损参考信号中存在至少一个路损参考信号为所述第一指示命令指示的一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号的情况下,所述至少一个路损参考信号对应的应用时间为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间,或者,为所述任一个TCI状态 对应的所述设定应用时间+N个样点;其中,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,对于PLRS的应用,如果网络侧设备事先指示了一组TCI状态,可以再向终端下发一第二指示命令,并通过第二指示命令指示一组PLRS,然后可以判断该PLRS是否为网络侧设备事先指示的一组TCI状态中的参考信号,如果存在至少一个PLRS为该一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号,则将该至少一个PLRS对应的应用时间确定为该任一个TCI状态所对应的设定应用时间,或者,为该任一个TCI状态对应的设定应用时间+N个样点。即如果一组PLRS中的任一个PLRS是一组TCI state中的TCI state中的参考信号,则该PLRS对应的应用时间与上述各实施例的BAT相同或BAT+N样点。
可选地,若所述一组路损参考信号中存在任一路损参考信号不为所述一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态所包含的参考信号,则所述任一路损参考信号对应的应用时间为如下之一:
第三预设时间;
第三预设时间+N个样点;
第三预设时间+第三预设时长;
第三预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
所述设定应用时间;
所述设定应用时间+N样点;
其中,所述第三预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可以理解为,对于PLRS的应用,如果网络侧设备事先指示了一组TCI状态,且又通过第二指示命令指示了一组PLRS,则可以判断该 PLRS是否为网络侧设备事先指示的一组TCI状态中的参考信号,如果存在任一PLRS不为该一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态中的参考信号,则将该任一PLRS对应的应用时间确定为:现有协议中的应用时间,或者,现有协议中的应用时间+第三预设时长,或者,上述各实施例中的BAT,或者,上述各实施例中的BAT+N sample,或者,上述各实施例中的BAT+N sample+第三预设时长,或者,与上述各实施例类似,根据PLRS所关联的panel的状态,确定其应用时间,具体包括上述列举的应用时间中的任一个。
可选地,所述第三预设时间为如下之一:
所述第二指示命令的传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可以理解为,与上述实施例类似,对于PLRS,可以由协议约定或网络侧设备配置的与panel激活状态无关的第三预设时间为上述列举的应用时间中的任一个。
可选地,在所述信息信号为跟踪参考信号TRS,且所述第一指示命令指示的TRS为周期或半持续TRS的情况下,所述周期或半持续TRS对应的所述第一预设时间为:所述网络侧设备配置的所述周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。
可以理解为,对于上述实施例中的信息信号具体是跟踪参考信号TRS的情况,如果TRS是周期或半持续TRS,则根据上述实施例中的第一预设时间为现有协议中周期或半持续TRS的传输时间,具体可以是网络侧设备配置的周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。其中,传输时间是根据该网络侧设备配置的周期或半持续TRS传输的周期值和偏移值确定的。 则在跟踪参考信号TRS对应的第一指示命令后,在TRS的传输时间基础上,若为未激活panel,则还需加第一预设时长,若为激活panel,则不需要加第一预设时长。
例如,如果TRS是周期TRS,网络侧设备使用RRC信令配置了该周期TRS的传输时间信息(周期值和时间偏移值),如周期值为5ms,时间偏移为1ms,则TRS的传输时间为第1ms、6ms、11ms......。若对应的目标天线面板为去激活态,且天线面板激活时延为8ms,则TRS的实际传输时间需要将原传输时间推迟天线面板的激活时延这一时长,即该周期TRS的设定应用时间为1ms+8ms、6ms+8ms、11ms+8ms......,也即9ms、14ms、19ms......。其中,第一预设时间为1ms、6ms、11ms......,第一预设时长为8ms。如果TRS对应的目标天线面板是激活态,即TRS是由终端使用激活态的目标天线面板进行测量的,则上述设定应用时间中的第一预设时长不再需要,也即该周期TRS的设定应用时间为1ms、6ms、11ms......。
在所述信息信号为非周期TRS时,网络侧设备使用第一指示命令触发非周期TRS,具体的设定应用时间与波束切换和PLRS更新的方法相同。
整体而言,当网络侧设备使用第一指示命令触发或配置或激活了TRS时,可以根据TRS关联的panel状态,确定TRS的应用时间(如传输时间或UE测量TRS的时间)为如下之一:
第一指示命令后的第一预设时间,若TRS对应的目标天线面板为未激活panel,则还需加第一预设时长,若为激活panel,则不需要加;
第一指示命令的ACK传输时间后的第一预设时间,若TRS对应的目标天线面板为未激活panel,则还需加第一预设时长,若为激活panel,则不需要加。
或者,总是使用TRS的传输时间,或TRS的传输时间+第一预设时长。
或者,若TRS对应多个panel标识信息,则:可根据对应不同panel标识信息的TRS的测量结果(如测量值的大小等),确定panel状态,或可由UE自行确定panel状态;再根据panel状态,确定TRS的传输时间或UE测量TRS的时间。
应理解的是,其中得到第一预设时间、第一预设时长的含义及确定方式可与上述各实施例相同,此处不再赘述。
可选地,在所述网络侧设备下发所述第一指示命令之前,所述方法还包括:所述网络侧设备接收波束报告,所述波束报告为所述终端根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备上报的。
具体而言,以波束切换为例,本申请实施例可以理解为,在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令以指示具体待更新的信息信号之前,终端可以先进行波束信息测量,并根据测量结果,生成对应的波束报告上报给网络侧设备。对应的网络侧设备可以接收该波束报告。可选地,网络侧设备可以根据终端上报的波束报告,下发第一指示命令,指示一组待更新的波束信息。
可以理解,在做波束测量时,网络侧设备可以在参考信号资源配置(RS resource config,或RS resource setting)中配置参考信号资源集合(RS resource set),其中包括至少一个参考信号资源,例如SSB resource或CSI-RS resource。UE测量每个RS resource的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,并将最优的至少一个测量结果上报给网络,上报内容例如可以包括SSBRI或CRI及其对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR。此外,还可以上报对应每个SSRBI/CRI的各个L1-RSRP/L1-SINR测量结果所使用的panel标识信息。
可选地,所述波束报告中包括如下信息中至少之一:
SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR;
天线面板标识信息,所述天线面板标识信息与SSBRI/CRI相对应。
具体而言,在终端向网络侧设备上报的上述波束报告中,可以选择 性包含上述内容中的任一项或者任意多项的组合。如仅包括SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,或仅包括天线面板标识信息,或同时包括SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR,以及天线面板标识信息。
其中,天线面板标识信息可以与SSBRI/CRI相对应,即在波束报告中每个SSBRI/CRI都有一个或多个相应的天线面板标识信息,不同的SSBRI/CRI对应的天线面板标识信息可以相同或者不同。
需要说明的是,本申请实施例提供的网络侧的信息信号的更新方法,执行主体可以为信息信号的更新装置,或者,该信息信号的更新装置中的用于执行加载网络侧信息信号的更新方法的控制模块。本申请实施例中以信息信号的更新装置执行网络侧信息信号的更新方法为例,说明本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置。
本申请实施例的信息信号的更新装置的结构如图5所示,为本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置的结构示意图之二,该装置可以用于实现上述的网络侧设备对应的各信息信号的更新方法实施例中信息信号的更新,该装置包括:
第二处理模块501,用于下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
预设固定常量;
根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可选地,所述目标天线面板按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号,且所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或所述至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至所述目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,通过所述标识信息确定所述至少一 个信息信号对应的所述目标天线面板;
在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,根据所述第一指示命令中包括的至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板的标识信息,确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可选地,在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,所述目标天线面板按如下方式确定:
在所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板,或者,根据第一预设规则,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中的一个为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可选地,所述第一预设规则,包括以下至少之一:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中最大者对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板;
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
可选地,所述目标天线面板的激活状态按如下方式中至少之一确定:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的第一报告中包括所述目标天线面板的激活状态信息的情况下,根据所述第一报告,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板的标识信息包括在所述终端向所述网络侧设备 发送的波束报告中的情况下,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,否则确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,根据第二预设规则,确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态;
在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态。
可选地,所述第二预设规则,包括:
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中前M个较大值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除所述前M个较大值以外的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,M为正整数;
或者,
在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将除所述P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息之外的目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,P为正整数;
或者,
将所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息对应的多个目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设 备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
第一预设时间;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态的情况下,所述设定应用时间由协议约定或者由所述网络侧设备配置始终为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信 息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可选地,所述设定应用时间由协议约定固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值,所述第一预设时长由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间,所述第一应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第二应用时间,所述第二应用时间为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第三应用时间,所述第三应用时间固定为如下之一:
第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
第二预设时间+N个样点;
第二预设时间;
其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,本申请实施例所述的信息信号的更新方法,还包括:所述网络侧设备向所述终端下发第二指示命令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号;
则,在所述一组路损参考信号中存在至少一个路损参考信号为所述第一指示命令指示的一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号的情况下,所述至少一个路损参考信号对应的应用时间为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间,或者,为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
其中,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,若所述一组路损参考信号中存在任一路损参考信号不为所述一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态所包含的参考信号,则所述任一路损参考信号对应的应用时间为如下之一:
第三预设时间;
第三预设时间+N个样点;
第三预设时间+第三预设时长;
第三预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
所述设定应用时间;
所述设定应用时间+N样点;
其中,所述第三预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
可选地,所述第三预设时间为如下之一:
所述第二指示命令的传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间;
所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
可选地,在所述信息信号为跟踪参考信号TRS,且所述第一指示命令指示的TRS为周期或半持续TRS的情况下,所述周期或半持续TRS对应的所述第一预设时间为:
所述网络侧设备配置的所述周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。
可选地,所述关联,包括如下至少之一:
所述信息信号中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述信息信号中的参考信号的配置信息中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
在所述参考信号所属的参考信号配置/资源集/组/子集/资源中,包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号中的参考信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
所述信息信号中的参考信号是基于所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告确定的,且所述波束报告中包括SSBRI/CRI及与所述SSBRI/CRI对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息。
可选地,还包括:
接收模块,用于在所述网络侧设备下发所述第一指示命令之前,接收波束报告,所述波束报告为所述终端根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备上报的。
可选地,所述波束报告中包括如下信息中至少之一:
SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR;
天线面板标识信息,所述天线面板标识信息与SSBRI/CRI相对应。
本申请实施例中的信息信号的更新装置可以是装置,具有操作系统的装置或电子设备,也可以是网络侧设备中的部件、集成电路、或芯片。该装置或电子设备可以包括但不限于上述所列举的网络侧设备102的类型,本申请实施例不作具体限定。
本申请实施例中的信息信号的更新装置可以为具有操作系统的装置。该操作系统可以为安卓(Android)操作系统,可以为IOS操作系统,还可以为其他可能的操作系统,本申请实施例不作具体限定。
本申请实施例提供的信息信号的更新装置能够实现图4的方法实施例实现的各个过程,并达到相同的技术效果,为避免重复,这里不再赘述。
如图6所示,本申请实施例还提供一种通信设备600,包括处理器601、存储器602以及存储在存储器602上并可在所述处理器601上运行的程序或指令。该通信设备可以是终端或网络侧设备,例如,当该通信设备600为终端时,该程序或指令被处理器601执行时实现上述终端的信息信号的更新方法实施例的各个过程,且能达到相同的技术效果。当该通信设备600为网络侧设备时,该程序或指令被处理器601执行时实现上述网络侧设备的信息信号的更新方法实施例的各个过程,且能达到相同的技术效果,为避免重复,这里不再赘述。
本申请实施例还提供一种终端,包括处理器和通信接口,其中,所述处理器用于在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成 所述信息信号的更新;其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:预设固定常量;根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。该终端实施例是与上述终端侧方法实施例对应的,上述方法实施例的各个实施过程和实现方式均可适用于该终端实施例中,且能达到相同的技术效果。
具体地,图7为实现本申请实施例的一种终端的硬件结构示意图。该终端700包括但不限于:射频单元701、网络模块702、音频输出单元703、输入单元704、传感器705、显示单元706、用户输入单元707、接口单元708、存储器709、以及处理器710等中的至少部分部件。
本领域技术人员可以理解,终端700还可以包括给各个部件供电的电源(比如电池),电源可以通过电源管理系统与处理器710逻辑相连,从而通过电源管理系统实现管理充电、放电、以及功耗管理等功能。图7中示出的终端结构并不构成对终端的限定,终端可以包括比图示更多或更少的部件,或者组合某些部件,或者不同的部件布置,在此不再赘述。
应理解的是,本申请实施例中,输入单元704可以包括图形处理器(Graphics Processing Unit,GPU)7041和麦克风7042,图形处理器7041对在视频捕获模式或图像捕获模式中由图像捕获装置(如摄像头)获得的静态图片或视频的图像数据进行处理。显示单元706可包括显示面板7061,可以采用液晶显示器、有机发光二极管等形式来配置显示面板7061。用户输入单元707包括触控面板7071以及其他输入设备7072。触控面板7071,也称为触摸屏。触控面板7071可包括触摸检测装置和触摸控制器两个部分。其他输入设备7072可以包括但不限于物理键盘、功能键(比如音量控制按键、开关按键等)、轨迹球、鼠标、操作杆,在此不再赘述。
本申请实施例中,射频单元701将来自网络侧设备的下行数据接收后,给处理器710处理;另外,将上行的数据发送给网络侧设备。通常,射频单元701包括但不限于天线、至少一个放大器、收发信机、耦合器、低噪声放大器、双工器等。
存储器709可用于存储软件程序或指令以及各种数据。存储器709可主要包括存储程序或指令区和存储数据区,其中,存储程序或指令区可存储操作系统、至少一个功能所需的应用程序或指令(比如声音播放功能、图像播放功能等)等。此外,存储器709可以包括高速随机存取存储器,还可以包括非易失性存储器,其中,非易失性存储器可以是只读存储器(Read-Only Memory,ROM)、可编程只读存储器(Programmable ROM,PROM)、可擦除可编程只读存储器(Erasable PROM,EPROM)、电可擦除可编程只读存储器(Electrically EPROM,EEPROM)或闪存。例如至少一个磁盘存储器件、闪存器件、或其他非易失性固态存储器件。
处理器710可包括一个或多个处理单元;可选的,处理器710可集成应用处理器和调制解调处理器,其中,应用处理器主要处理操作系统、用户界面和应用程序或指令等,调制解调处理器主要处理无线通信,如基带处理器。可以理解的是,上述调制解调处理器也可以不集成到处理器710中。
其中,处理器710,用于在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新。
本申请实施例中,在网络侧设备通过指示命令指示了信息信号的更新的情况下,根据确定的目标天线面板的激活状态,设定实现更新的应用时间,并在该应用时间,完成网络侧指示的信息信号的更新,能够使网络侧和UE的更新时间对齐,从而可以维持正确的波束链路,保证数据传输性能。
可选的,射频单元701,用于接收所述网络侧设备下发的第二指示命 令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号。
可选的,射频单元701,还用于根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备发送波束报告。
可选的,处理器710,还用于在信息测量的过程中,将当前为去激活态的天线面板激活后,进行信息测量,并在信息测量结束之后或者发送所述波束报告之后,将所述激活的天线面板再去激活。
本申请实施例中,在信息测量过程中将去激活的天线面板激活,并在测量结束后将天线面板再去激活,能够有效节约能源,提高整体效益。
本申请实施例还提供一种网络侧设备,包括处理器和通信接口,处理器用于下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:预设固定常量;根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。该网络侧设备实施例是与上述网络侧设备方法实施例对应的,上述方法实施例的各个实施过程和实现方式均可适用于该网络侧设备实施例中,且能达到相同的技术效果。
具体地,图8为实现本申请实施例的一种网络侧设备的硬件结构示意图,如图8所示,该网络设备800包括但不限于:天线801、射频装置802和基带装置803。天线801与射频装置802连接。
在上行方向上,射频装置802通过天线801接收信息,将接收的信息发送给基带装置803进行处理。在下行方向上,基带装置803对要发送的信息进行处理,并发送给射频装置802,射频装置802对收到的信息进行处理后经过天线801发送出去。
本领域技术人员可以理解,图8中示出的网络侧设备的结构并不构成对本申请网络侧设备的限定,本申请网络侧设备可以包括比图示更多 或更少的部件,或者组合某些部件,或者不同的部件布置,在此不再赘述。
基带装置803中可以包括频带处理装置,以上实施例中网络侧设备执行的方法可以在基带装置803中实现,该基带装置803包括处理器804和存储器805。
基带装置803例如可以包括至少一个基带板,该基带板上设置有多个芯片,如图8所示,其中一个芯片例如为处理器804,与存储器805连接,以调用存储器805中的程序,执行以上方法实施例中所示的网络侧设备的操作。
该基带装置803还可以包括网络接口806,用于与射频装置802交互信息,该接口例如为通用公共无线接口(common public radio interface,简称CPRI)。
具体地,本发明实施例的网络侧设备还包括:存储在存储器805上并可在处理器804上运行的指令或程序,处理器804调用存储器805中的指令或程序执行以上各实施例中网络侧设备侧执行的信息信号的更新方法,并达到相同的技术效果,为避免重复,故不在此赘述。
本申请实施例还提供一种可读存储介质,所述可读存储介质上存储有程序或指令,该程序或指令被处理器执行时实现上述信息信号的更新方法实施例的各个过程,且能达到相同的技术效果,为避免重复,这里不再赘述。
其中,所述处理器为上述实施例中所述的终端或网络侧设备中的处理器。所述可读存储介质,包括计算机可读存储介质,如计算机只读存储器(Read-Only Memory,ROM)、随机存取存储器(Random Access Memory,RAM)、磁碟或者光盘等。
本申请实施例另提供了一种芯片,所述芯片包括处理器和通信接口,所述通信接口和所述处理器耦合,所述处理器用于运行程序或指令,实现上述信息信号的更新方法实施例的各个过程,且能达到相同的 技术效果,为避免重复,这里不再赘述。
应理解,本申请实施例提到的芯片还可以称为系统级芯片,系统芯片,芯片系统或片上系统芯片等。
本申请实施例另提供了一种计算机程序/程序产品,所述计算机程序/程序产品被存储在非瞬态的存储介质中,所述程序/程序产品被至少一个处理器执行以实现上述信息信号的更新方法实施例的各个过程,且能达到相同的技术效果,为避免重复,这里不再赘述。
需要说明的是,在本文中,术语“包括”、“包含”或者其任何其他变体意在涵盖非排他性的包含,从而使得包括一系列要素的过程、方法、物品或者装置不仅包括那些要素,而且还包括没有明确列出的其他要素,或者是还包括为这种过程、方法、物品或者装置所固有的要素。在没有更多限制的情况下,由语句“包括一个......”限定的要素,并不排除在包括该要素的过程、方法、物品或者装置中还存在另外的相同要素。此外,需要指出的是,本申请实施方式中的方法和装置的范围不限按示出或讨论的顺序来执行功能,还可包括根据所涉及的功能按基本同时的方式或按相反的顺序来执行功能,例如,可以按不同于所描述的次序来执行所描述的方法,并且还可以添加、省去、或组合各种步骤。另外,参照某些示例所描述的特征可在其他示例中被组合。
通过以上的实施方式的描述,本领域的技术人员可以清楚地了解到上述实施例方法可借助软件加必需的通用硬件平台的方式来实现,当然也可以通过硬件,但很多情况下前者是更佳的实施方式。基于这样的理解,本申请的技术方案本质上或者说对现有技术做出贡献的部分可以以计算机软件产品的形式体现出来,该计算机软件产品存储在一个存储介质(如ROM/RAM、磁碟、光盘)中,包括若干指令用以使得一台终端(可以是手机,计算机,服务器,或者网络设备等)执行本申请各个实施例所述的方法。
上面结合附图对本申请的实施例进行了描述,但是本申请并不局限于 上述的具体实施方式,上述的具体实施方式仅仅是示意性的,而不是限制性的,本领域的普通技术人员在本申请的启示下,在不脱离本申请宗旨和权利要求所保护的范围情况下,还可做出很多形式,均属于本申请的保护之内。

Claims (83)

  1. 一种信息信号的更新方法,包括:
    终端在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
    其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或所述终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
    预设固定常量;
    根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  2. 根据权利要求1所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述目标天线面板按如下方式中至少之一确定:
    在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号,且所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至所述目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,通过所述标识信息确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述目标天线面板;
    在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,根据所述第一指示命令中包括的至少一个信息信号对应的天线面板的标识信息,确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  3. 根据权利要求1所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,所述目标天线面板按如下方式确定:
    在所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板,或者,根据第一预设规则,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中的一个为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天 线面板。
  4. 根据权利要求3所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第一预设规则,包括以下至少之一:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中最大者对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板;
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  5. 根据权利要求2或3或4所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述目标天线面板的激活状态按如下方式中至少之一确定:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的第一报告中包括所述目标天线面板的激活状态信息的情况下,根据所述第一报告,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态;
    在所述目标天线面板的标识信息包括在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的波束报告中的情况下,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,否则确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态;
    在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,根据第二预设规则,确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态;
    在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态。
  6. 根据权利要求5所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设规则,包括:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息 分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中前M个较大值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除所述前M个较大值以外的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,M为正整数;
    或者,
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将除所述P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息之外的目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,P为正整数;
    或者,
    将所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息对应的多个目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
  7. 根据权利要求2-4、6中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
    第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  8. 根据权利要求7所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  9. 根据权利要求2-4、6中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
    第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置。
  10. 根据权利要求9所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  11. 根据权利要求5所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态的情况下,所述设定应用时间由协议约定或者由所述网络侧设备配置固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  12. 根据权利要求1-4任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述设定应用时间固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设 时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值或者为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长。
  13. 根据权利要求2-4、6中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间,所述第一应用时间为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  14. 根据权利要求13所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  15. 根据权利要求2-4、6中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的 第二应用时间,所述第二应用时间为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点;
    第二预设时间;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  16. 根据权利要求15所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  17. 根据权利要求1-4任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第三应用时间,所述第三应用时间固定为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+N个样点;
    第二预设时间;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  18. 根据权利要求17所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  19. 根据权利要求1-4任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,还包括:所述终端接收所述网络侧设备下发的第二指示命令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号;
    则,在所述一组路损参考信号中存在至少一个路损参考信号为所述第一指示命令指示的一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号的情况下,所述至少一个路损参考信号对应的应用时间为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间,或者,为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
    其中,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  20. 根据权利要求19所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,若所述一组路损参考信号中存在任一路损参考信号不为所述一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态所包含的参考信号,则所述任一路损参考信号对应的应用时间为如下之一:
    第三预设时间;
    第三预设时间+N个样点;
    第三预设时间+第三预设时长;
    第三预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    所述设定应用时间;
    所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
    其中,所述第三预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  21. 根据权利要求20所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第三预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第二指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第二指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  22. 根据权利要求7所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为跟踪参考信号TRS,且所述第一指示命令指示的TRS为周期或半持续TRS的情况下,所述周期或半持续TRS对应的所述第一预设时间为:
    所述网络侧设备配置的所述周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。
  23. 根据权利要求2-4、6、8、10、11、14、16、22中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述关联,包括如下至少之一:
    所述信息信号中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    所述信息信号中的参考信号的配置信息中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    在所述参考信号所属的参考信号配置/资源集/组/子集/资源中,包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应 的编号;
    所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
    所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号中的参考信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
    所述信息信号中的参考信号是基于所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告确定的,且所述波束报告中包括SSBRI/CRI及与所述SSBRI/CRI对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息。
  24. 根据权利要求1-4任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述网络侧设备下发所述第一指示命令之前,所述方法还包括:
    所述终端根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备发送波束报告。
  25. 根据权利要求4所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述波束报告中包括如下信息中至少之一:
    SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR;
    天线面板标识信息,所述天线面板标识信息与SSBRI/CRI相对应。
  26. 根据权利要求24所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述终端在信息测量的过程中,将当前为去激活态的天线面板激活后,进行信息测量,并在信息测量结束之后或者发送所述波束报告之后,将所述激活的天线面板再去激活。
  27. 一种信息信号的更新装置,其中,包括:
    第一处理模块,用于在网络侧设备下发第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
    其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
    预设固定常量;
    根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  28. 根据权利要求27所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述目标天线面板按如下方式中至少之一确定:
    在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号,且所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至所述目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,通过所述标识信息确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述目标天线面板;
    在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,根据所述第一指示命令中包括的至少一个信息信号对应的天线面板的标识信息,确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  29. 根据权利要求27所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,所述目标天线面板按如下方式确定:
    在所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板,或者,根据第一预设规则,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中的一个为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  30. 根据权利要求29所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第一预设规则,包括以下至少之一:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中最大者对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板;
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线 面板标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  31. 根据权利要求28或29或30所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述目标天线面板的激活状态按如下方式中至少之一确定:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的第一报告中包括所述目标天线面板的激活状态信息的情况下,根据所述第一报告,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态;
    在所述目标天线面板的标识信息包括在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的波束报告中的情况下,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,否则确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态;
    在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,根据第二预设规则,确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态;
    在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态。
  32. 根据权利要求31所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第二预设规则,包括:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中前M个较大值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除所述前M个较大值以外的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,M为正整数;
    或者,
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将除所述P个所述 目标天线面板的标识信息之外的目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,P为正整数;
    或者,
    将所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息对应的多个目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
  33. 根据权利要求28-30、32中任一所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
    第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  34. 根据权利要求33所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  35. 根据权利要求28-30、32中任一所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
    第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置。
  36. 根据权利要求35所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  37. 根据权利要求31所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态的情况下,所述设定应用时间由协议约定或者由所述网络侧设备配置固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  38. 根据权利要求27-30任一项所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述设定应用时间固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值或者为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长。
  39. 根据权利要求28-30、32中任一所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间,所述第一应用时间为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  40. 根据权利要求39所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  41. 根据权利要求28-30、32中任一所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第二应用时间,所述第二应用时间为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点;
    第二预设时间;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  42. 根据权利要求41所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  43. 根据权利要求27-30任一项所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第三应用时间,所述第三应用时间固定为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+N个样点;
    第二预设时间;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  44. 根据权利要求43所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  45. 根据权利要求27-30任一项所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中, 还包括:
    接收模块,用于接收所述网络侧设备下发的第二指示命令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号;
    则,在所述一组路损参考信号中存在至少一个路损参考信号为所述第一指示命令指示的一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号的情况下,所述至少一个路损参考信号对应的应用时间为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间,或者,为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
    其中,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  46. 根据权利要求45所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,若所述一组路损参考信号中存在任一路损参考信号不为所述一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态所包含的参考信号,则所述任一路损参考信号对应的应用时间为如下之一:
    第三预设时间;
    第三预设时间+N个样点;
    第三预设时间+第三预设时长;
    第三预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    所述设定应用时间;
    所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
    其中,所述第三预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  47. 根据权利要求46所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述第三预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第二指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第二指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  48. 根据权利要求33所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,在所述信息信号为跟踪参考信号TRS,且所述第一指示命令指示的TRS为周期或半持续TRS的情况下,所述周期或半持续TRS对应的所述第一预设时间为:
    所述网络侧设备配置的所述周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。
  49. 根据权利要求28-30、32、34、36、37、40、42、48中任一所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述关联,包括如下至少之一:
    所述信息信号中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    所述信息信号中的参考信号的配置信息中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    在所述参考信号所属的参考信号配置/资源集/组/子集/资源中,包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
    所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号中的参考信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
    所述信息信号中的参考信号是基于所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告确定的,且所述波束报告中包括SSBRI/CRI及与所述 SSBRI/CRI对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息。
  50. 根据权利要求27-30任一项所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,还包括第一发送模块,用于:在所述网络侧设备下发所述第一指示命令之前,根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备发送波束报告。
  51. 根据权利要求30所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,所述波束报告中包括如下信息中至少之一:
    SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR;
    天线面板标识信息,所述天线面板标识信息与SSBRI/CRI相对应。
  52. 根据权利要求50所述的信息信号的更新装置,其中,还包括第一测量模块,用于:
    在信息测量的过程中,将当前为去激活态的天线面板激活后,进行信息测量,并在信息测量结束之后或者发送所述波束报告之后,将所述激活的天线面板再去激活。
  53. 一种信息信号的更新方法,包括:
    网络侧设备下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
    其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由所述网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
    预设固定常量;
    根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  54. 根据权利要求53所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述目标天线面板按如下方式中至少之一确定:
    在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号,且所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或所述至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至所述目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,通过所述标识信息确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述目标天线面板;
    在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,根据所述第一指示命令中包括的至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板的标识信息,确定所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  55. 根据权利要求53所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述第一指示命令指示一组信息信号的情况下,所述目标天线面板按如下方式确定:
    在所述一组信息信号中存在至少一个信息信号或至少一个信息信号中的参考信号关联至多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板,或者,根据第一预设规则,确定所述多个天线面板标识信息对应的多个天线面板中的一个为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  56. 根据权利要求55所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第一预设规则,包括以下至少之一:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个天线面板标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中最大者对应的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板;
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个天线面板标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的天线面板标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为所述至少一个信息信号对应的目标天线面板。
  57. 根据权利要求54或55或56所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述目标天线面板的激活状态按如下方式中至少之一确定:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的第一报告中包括所述目标天线面板的激活状态信息的情况下,根据所述第一报告,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态;
    在所述目标天线面板的标识信息包括在所述终端向所述网络侧设备发送的波束报告中的情况下,确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态,否则确定所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态;
    在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,根据第二预设规则,确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态;
    在所述目标天线面板为多个目标天线面板的情况下,通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态。
  58. 根据权利要求57所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设规则,包括:
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,比较所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息分别对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值,并将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中前M个较大值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将所述L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值中除所述前M个较大值以外的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR值对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,M为正整数;
    或者,
    在所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告中包括所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息的情况下,将排列在预设位置的P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为激活态,且将除所述P个所述目标天线面板的标识信息之外的目标天线面板的标识信息所对应的天线面板确定为去激活态,P为正整数;
    或者,
    将所述多个目标天线面板的标识信息对应的多个目标天线面板均确定为激活态。
  59. 根据权利要求54-56、58中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述至少一 个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
    第一预设时间+第一预设时长;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  60. 根据权利要求59所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  61. 根据权利要求54-56、58中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述至少一个信息信号对应的所述设定应用时间为:
    第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置。
  62. 根据权利要求61所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第一预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备 配置。
  63. 根据权利要求62所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述通过所述终端自确定所述多个目标天线面板的激活状态的情况下,所述设定应用时间由协议约定或者由所述网络侧设备配置始终为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第一预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  64. 根据权利要求53-56任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述设定应用时间由协议约定固定为第一预设时间+第一预设时长,或者,为第一预设时间;
    其中,所述第一预设时间为协议约定的固定值,所述第一预设时长由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  65. 根据权利要求54-56、58中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为去激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第一应用时间,所述第一应用时间为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N样点+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  66. 根据权利要求65所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  67. 根据权利要求54-56、58中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号,且所述目标天线面板的激活状态为激活态的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第二应用时间,所述第二应用时间为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点;
    第二预设时间;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  68. 根据权利要求67所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  69. 根据权利要求53-56任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为路损参考信号的情况下,所述设定应用时间为待更新的路损参考信号对应的第三应用时间,所述第三应用时间固定为如下之一:
    第二预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+第三预设时长;
    第二预设时间+N个样点;
    第二预设时间;
    其中,所述第二预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  70. 根据权利要求69所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第二预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第一指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  71. 根据权利要求53-56任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,还包括:所述网络侧设备向所述终端下发第二指示命令,所述第二指示命令指示一组路损参考信号;
    则,在所述一组路损参考信号中存在至少一个路损参考信号为所述第一指示命令指示的一组TCI状态中任一个TCI状态中的参考信号的情况下,所述至少一个路损参考信号对应的应用时间为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间,或者,为所述任一个TCI状态对应的所述设定应用时间+N个样点;
    其中,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  72. 根据权利要求71所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,若所述一组路损参考信号中存在任一路损参考信号不为所述一组TCI状态中任一TCI状态所包含的参考信号,则所述任一路损参考信号对应的应用时间为如下之一:
    第三预设时间;
    第三预设时间+N个样点;
    第三预设时间+第三预设时长;
    第三预设时间+N个样点+第三预设时长;
    所述设定应用时间;
    所述设定应用时间+N样点;
    其中,所述第三预设时间为协议约定的固定值或者由所述网络侧设备配置,所述第三预设时长为由所述网络侧设备根据所述终端的能力信息配置的满足天线面板激活时延的时长,或者,为由协议约定为根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值,N为协议约定或所述网络侧设备配置的预设常量或者为基于所述终端的能力信息确定的值。
  73. 根据权利要求72所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述第三预设时间为如下之一:
    所述第二指示命令的传输时间;
    所述第二指示命令的传输时间+第二预设时长;
    所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间;
    所述第二指示命令的ACK传输时间+第二预设时长;
    其中,所述第二预设时长为协议约定的预设值或由所述网络侧设备配置。
  74. 根据权利要求59所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述信息信号为跟踪参考信号TRS,且所述第一指示命令指示的TRS为周期或半持续TRS的情况下,所述周期或半持续TRS对应的所述第一预设时间为:
    所述网络侧设备配置的所述周期或半持续TRS的传输时间。
  75. 根据权利要求54-56、58、60、62、63、66、68、74中任一所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述关联,包括如下至少之一:
    所述信息信号中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    所述信息信号中的参考信号的配置信息中包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    在所述参考信号所属的参考信号配置/资源集/组/子集/资源中,包括所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号;
    所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
    所述网络侧设备指示了所述信息信号中的参考信号与所述目标天线面板的标识信息或与所述目标天线面板的标识信息相对应的编号相关联;
    所述信息信号中的参考信号是基于所述终端向所述网络侧设备上报的波束报告确定的,且所述波束报告中包括SSBRI/CRI及与所述SSBRI/CRI对应的所述目标天线面板的标识信息。
  76. 根据权利要求53-56任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,在所述网络侧设备下发所述第一指示命令之前,所述方法还包括:
    所述网络侧设备接收波束报告,所述波束报告为所述终端根据测量结果,向所述网络侧设备上报的。
  77. 根据权利要求76所述的信息信号的更新方法,其中,所述波束报告中包括如下信息中至少之一:
    SSBRI/CRI及所述SSBRI/CRI对应的L1-RSRP/L1-SINR;
    天线面板标识信息,所述天线面板标识信息与SSBRI/CRI相对应。
  78. 一种信息信号的更新装置,包括:
    第二处理模块,用于下发第一指示命令,并在下发所述第一指示命令后的设定应用时间,完成所述信息信号的更新;
    其中,所述信息信号为所述第一指示命令指示的信息信号,所述设定应用时间由网络侧设备根据目标天线面板的激活状态和/或终端的能力信息确定,或者,由协议约定根据如下至少之一确定:
    预设固定常量;
    根据所述目标天线面板的激活状态确定的值。
  79. 一种终端,包括处理器,存储器及存储在所述存储器上并可在所述处理器上运行的程序或指令,所述程序或指令被所述处理器执行时实现如权利要求1至26任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法的步骤。
  80. 一种网络侧设备,包括处理器,存储器及存储在所述存储器上并可在所述处理器上运行的程序或指令,所述程序或指令被所述处理器执行时实现如权利要求53至77任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法的步骤。
  81. 一种可读存储介质,所述可读存储介质上存储程序或指令,所述程序或指令被处理器执行时,实现如权利要求1-26任一项或者如权利要求53至77任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法的步骤。
  82. 一种芯片,所述芯片包括处理器和通信接口,所述通信接口和所述处理器耦合,所述处理器用于运行程序或指令,实现如权利要求1至26任一项或者如权利要求53至77任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法的步骤。
  83. 一种计算机程序产品/程序产品,所述计算机程序/程序产品被存储在存储介质中,所述程序/程序产品被至少一个处理器执行以实现如权利要求1至26任一项或者如权利要求53至77任一项所述的信息信号的更新方法的步骤。
PCT/CN2022/086364 2021-04-12 2022-04-12 信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备 WO2022218305A1 (zh)

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
CN202110390545.8 2021-04-12
CN202110390545.8A CN115209498A (zh) 2021-04-12 2021-04-12 信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2022218305A1 true WO2022218305A1 (zh) 2022-10-20

Family

ID=83570822

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/CN2022/086364 WO2022218305A1 (zh) 2021-04-12 2022-04-12 信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备

Country Status (2)

Country Link
CN (1) CN115209498A (zh)
WO (1) WO2022218305A1 (zh)

Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN109587793A (zh) * 2017-09-29 2019-04-05 维沃移动通信有限公司 Tci状态更新方法、基站及终端
CN110536456A (zh) * 2018-05-25 2019-12-03 成都华为技术有限公司 通信方法、终端设备和网络设备
CN111818660A (zh) * 2019-08-05 2020-10-23 维沃移动通信有限公司 波束信息更新的方法、终端设备和网络设备

Family Cites Families (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11368948B2 (en) * 2019-05-03 2022-06-21 Mediatek Inc. Transmission configuration indication switching procedure in new radio mobile communications
US11729775B2 (en) * 2019-08-15 2023-08-15 Ofinno, Llc Antenna panel activation/deactivation

Patent Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN109587793A (zh) * 2017-09-29 2019-04-05 维沃移动通信有限公司 Tci状态更新方法、基站及终端
CN110536456A (zh) * 2018-05-25 2019-12-03 成都华为技术有限公司 通信方法、终端设备和网络设备
CN111818660A (zh) * 2019-08-05 2020-10-23 维沃移动通信有限公司 波束信息更新的方法、终端设备和网络设备

Non-Patent Citations (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
MEDIATEK INC.: "Enhancement on multi-beam operation", 3GPP DRAFT; R1-2100588, 3RD GENERATION PARTNERSHIP PROJECT (3GPP), MOBILE COMPETENCE CENTRE ; 650, ROUTE DES LUCIOLES ; F-06921 SOPHIA-ANTIPOLIS CEDEX ; FRANCE, vol. RAN WG1, no. e-Meeting; 20210125 - 20210205, 19 January 2021 (2021-01-19), Mobile Competence Centre ; 650, route des Lucioles ; F-06921 Sophia-Antipolis Cedex ; France , XP051971059 *
MEDIATEK INC.: "Enhancement on multi-beam operation", 3GPP DRAFT; R1-2102675, 3RD GENERATION PARTNERSHIP PROJECT (3GPP), MOBILE COMPETENCE CENTRE ; 650, ROUTE DES LUCIOLES ; F-06921 SOPHIA-ANTIPOLIS CEDEX ; FRANCE, vol. RAN WG1, no. e-Meeting; 20210412 - 20210420, 7 April 2021 (2021-04-07), Mobile Competence Centre ; 650, route des Lucioles ; F-06921 Sophia-Antipolis Cedex ; France, XP052177680 *

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
CN115209498A (zh) 2022-10-18

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US11546106B2 (en) Method and device for determining beam failure detection reference signal resource
US11973561B2 (en) Antenna panel application method, apparatus and storage medium
WO2021114276A1 (zh) 波束测量方法及波束测量装置
WO2022028373A1 (zh) 测量上报方法、装置及设备
WO2022089565A1 (zh) 辅小区组信息的配置、获取方法及通信设备
US20230080392A1 (en) Method for determining uplink transmission parameter, and terminal device
WO2022028455A1 (zh) 小区切换方法和终端
CN114765783A (zh) 波束切换方法、装置、终端及网络侧设备
WO2022218305A1 (zh) 信息信号的更新方法、终端及网络侧设备
WO2022156751A1 (zh) 路径切换的方法、终端及网络侧设备
WO2022095830A1 (zh) 资源测量的调整方法及装置、终端及可读存储介质
EP4195756A1 (en) Measurement method, measurement apparatus, terminal and network device
WO2022022635A1 (zh) 接入控制方法、装置、终端及网络设备
WO2022206740A1 (zh) 波束切换方法、装置及存储介质
WO2022068752A1 (zh) 通信资源激活方法、终端及网络侧设备
WO2024104078A1 (zh) 测量放松方法、终端及网络侧设备
WO2022237620A1 (zh) Csi测量资源的处理方法及装置、终端及可读存储介质
WO2023040933A1 (zh) 波束信息的确定方法、终端及网络侧设备
WO2022166942A1 (zh) 发射链路的处理方法、装置及终端
WO2022228526A1 (zh) 移动性管理的配置方法、装置、终端、网络侧设备及介质
WO2024022351A1 (zh) 测量方法、装置及设备
WO2022194200A1 (zh) 终端操作、配置方法、装置、终端及网络侧设备
WO2023011481A1 (zh) 波束信息确定方法、装置、通信设备及存储介质
US20230199538A1 (en) Candidate beam measurement method and terminal
WO2022148472A1 (zh) 波束质量测量方法和设备

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 22787528

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE